1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
6 <ian@cygnus.com>.
7 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
8 <mark@codesourcery.com>
9 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
10 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
11
12 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
13
14 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
15 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
16 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
17 (at your option) any later version.
18
19 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
20 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
21 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
22 GNU General Public License for more details.
23
24 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
25 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
26 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27
28 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
29
30 #include "sysdep.h"
31 #include "bfd.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "libiberty.h"
34 #include "elf-bfd.h"
35 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
36 #include "elf/mips.h"
37 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
38
39 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
40 #include "coff/sym.h"
41 #include "coff/symconst.h"
42 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
43 #include "coff/mips.h"
44
45 #include "hashtab.h"
46
47 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
48 There are three types of entry:
49
50 (1) absolute addresses
51 (abfd == NULL)
52 (2) SYMBOL + OFFSET addresses, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
53 (abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0)
54 (3) global and forced-local symbols
55 (abfd != NULL, symndx == -1)
56
57 Type (3) entries are treated differently for different types of GOT.
58 In the "master" GOT -- i.e. the one that describes every GOT
59 reference needed in the link -- the mips_got_entry is keyed on both
60 the symbol and the input bfd that references it. If it turns out
61 that we need multiple GOTs, we can then use this information to
62 create separate GOTs for each input bfd.
63
64 However, we want each of these separate GOTs to have at most one
65 entry for a given symbol, so their type (3) entries are keyed only
66 on the symbol. The input bfd given by the "abfd" field is somewhat
67 arbitrary in this case.
68
69 This means that when there are multiple GOTs, each GOT has a unique
70 mips_got_entry for every symbol within it. We can therefore use the
71 mips_got_entry fields (tls_type and gotidx) to track the symbol's
72 GOT index.
73
74 However, if it turns out that we need only a single GOT, we continue
75 to use the master GOT to describe it. There may therefore be several
76 mips_got_entries for the same symbol, each with a different input bfd.
77 We want to make sure that each symbol gets a unique GOT entry, so when
78 there's a single GOT, we use the symbol's hash entry, not the
79 mips_got_entry fields, to track a symbol's GOT index. */
80 struct mips_got_entry
81 {
82 /* The input bfd in which the symbol is defined. */
83 bfd *abfd;
84 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
85 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
86 long symndx;
87 union
88 {
89 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
90 bfd_vma address;
91 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
92 that should be added to the symbol value. */
93 bfd_vma addend;
94 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
95 corresponding to a global symbol in the got (or, local, if
96 h->forced_local). */
97 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
98 } d;
99
100 /* The TLS types included in this GOT entry (specifically, GD and
101 IE). The GD and IE flags can be added as we encounter new
102 relocations. LDM can also be set; it will always be alone, not
103 combined with any GD or IE flags. An LDM GOT entry will be
104 a local symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
105 unsigned char tls_type;
106
107 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
108 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
109 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
110 long gotidx;
111 };
112
113 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
114
115 struct mips_got_info
116 {
117 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
118 symbol table. */
119 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
120 /* The number of global .got entries. */
121 unsigned int global_gotno;
122 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
123 unsigned int tls_gotno;
124 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
125 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
126 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
127 /* The number of local .got entries. */
128 unsigned int local_gotno;
129 /* The number of local .got entries we have used. */
130 unsigned int assigned_gotno;
131 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
132 struct htab *got_entries;
133 /* A hash table mapping input bfds to other mips_got_info. NULL
134 unless multi-got was necessary. */
135 struct htab *bfd2got;
136 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
137 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
138 struct mips_got_info *next;
139 /* This is the GOT index of the TLS LDM entry for the GOT, MINUS_ONE
140 for none, or MINUS_TWO for not yet assigned. This is needed
141 because a single-GOT link may have multiple hash table entries
142 for the LDM. It does not get initialized in multi-GOT mode. */
143 bfd_vma tls_ldm_offset;
144 };
145
146 /* Map an input bfd to a got in a multi-got link. */
147
148 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash {
149 bfd *bfd;
150 struct mips_got_info *g;
151 };
152
153 /* Structure passed when traversing the bfd2got hash table, used to
154 create and merge bfd's gots. */
155
156 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
157 {
158 /* A hashtable that maps bfds to gots. */
159 htab_t bfd2got;
160 /* The output bfd. */
161 bfd *obfd;
162 /* The link information. */
163 struct bfd_link_info *info;
164 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
165 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
166 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
167 struct mips_got_info *primary;
168 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
169 gots. */
170 struct mips_got_info *current;
171 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
172 16-bit offset. */
173 unsigned int max_count;
174 /* The number of local and global entries in the primary got. */
175 unsigned int primary_count;
176 /* The number of local and global entries in the current got. */
177 unsigned int current_count;
178 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
179 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
180 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
181 the "master" GOT. */
182 unsigned int global_count;
183 };
184
185 /* Another structure used to pass arguments for got entries traversal. */
186
187 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg
188 {
189 struct mips_got_info *g;
190 int value;
191 unsigned int needed_relocs;
192 struct bfd_link_info *info;
193 };
194
195 /* A structure used to count TLS relocations or GOT entries, for GOT
196 entry or ELF symbol table traversal. */
197
198 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg
199 {
200 struct bfd_link_info *info;
201 unsigned int needed;
202 };
203
204 struct _mips_elf_section_data
205 {
206 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
207 union
208 {
209 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
210 bfd_byte *tdata;
211 } u;
212 };
213
214 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
215 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
216
217 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
218 the dynamic symbols. */
219
220 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
221 {
222 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
223 index. */
224 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
225 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
226 symbol with a GOT entry. */
227 long min_got_dynindx;
228 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
229 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
230 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
231 long max_unref_got_dynindx;
232 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index not corresponding to a
233 symbol without a GOT entry. */
234 long max_non_got_dynindx;
235 };
236
237 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
238 the global hash table. */
239
240 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
241 {
242 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
243
244 /* External symbol information. */
245 EXTR esym;
246
247 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
248 this symbol. */
249 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
250
251 /* If the R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 reloc is against
252 a readonly section. */
253 bfd_boolean readonly_reloc;
254
255 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
256 related to taking the function's address, i.e. any but
257 R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones -- see "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition",
258 p. 4-20. */
259 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub;
260
261 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
262 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
263 asection *fn_stub;
264
265 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is set if this symbol appears
266 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
267 bfd_boolean need_fn_stub;
268
269 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
270 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
271 asection *call_stub;
272
273 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
274 being called returns a floating point value. */
275 asection *call_fp_stub;
276
277 /* Are we forced local? This will only be set if we have converted
278 the initial global GOT entry to a local GOT entry. */
279 bfd_boolean forced_local;
280
281 /* Are we referenced by some kind of relocation? */
282 bfd_boolean is_relocation_target;
283
284 /* Are we referenced by branch relocations? */
285 bfd_boolean is_branch_target;
286
287 #define GOT_NORMAL 0
288 #define GOT_TLS_GD 1
289 #define GOT_TLS_LDM 2
290 #define GOT_TLS_IE 4
291 #define GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE 0x40
292 #define GOT_TLS_DONE 0x80
293 unsigned char tls_type;
294 /* This is only used in single-GOT mode; in multi-GOT mode there
295 is one mips_got_entry per GOT entry, so the offset is stored
296 there. In single-GOT mode there may be many mips_got_entry
297 structures all referring to the same GOT slot. It might be
298 possible to use root.got.offset instead, but that field is
299 overloaded already. */
300 bfd_vma tls_got_offset;
301 };
302
303 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
304
305 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
306 {
307 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
308 #if 0
309 /* We no longer use this. */
310 /* String section indices for the dynamic section symbols. */
311 bfd_size_type dynsym_sec_strindex[SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES];
312 #endif
313 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
314 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
315 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
316 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
317 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic
318 entry is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5. */
319 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
320 /* This is the value of the __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
321 bfd_vma rld_value;
322 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
323 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
324 /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks. */
325 bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
326 /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
327 being used. */
328 asection *srelbss;
329 asection *sdynbss;
330 asection *srelplt;
331 asection *srelplt2;
332 asection *sgotplt;
333 asection *splt;
334 /* The size of the PLT header in bytes (VxWorks only). */
335 bfd_vma plt_header_size;
336 /* The size of a PLT entry in bytes (VxWorks only). */
337 bfd_vma plt_entry_size;
338 /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes. */
339 bfd_vma function_stub_size;
340 };
341
342 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
343 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
344 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
345 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
346 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
347 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
348 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
349 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
350 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
351 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
352 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
353 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
354 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
355 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
356
357 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
358
359 struct extsym_info
360 {
361 bfd *abfd;
362 struct bfd_link_info *info;
363 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
364 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
365 bfd_boolean failed;
366 };
367
368 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
369
370 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
371 {
372 "_procedure_table",
373 "_procedure_string_table",
374 "_procedure_table_size",
375 NULL
376 };
377
378 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
379 IRIX5. */
380
381 typedef struct
382 {
383 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
384 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
385 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
386 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
387 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
388 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
389 } Elf32_compact_rel;
390
391 typedef struct
392 {
393 bfd_byte id1[4];
394 bfd_byte num[4];
395 bfd_byte id2[4];
396 bfd_byte offset[4];
397 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
398 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
399 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
400
401 typedef struct
402 {
403 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
404 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
405 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
406 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
407 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
408 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
409 } Elf32_crinfo;
410
411 typedef struct
412 {
413 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
414 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
415 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
416 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
417 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
418 } Elf32_crinfo2;
419
420 typedef struct
421 {
422 bfd_byte info[4];
423 bfd_byte konst[4];
424 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
425 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
426
427 typedef struct
428 {
429 bfd_byte info[4];
430 bfd_byte konst[4];
431 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
432
433 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
434
435 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
436 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
437 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
438 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
439 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
440 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
441 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
442 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
443
444 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
445 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
446 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
447 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
448 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
449
450 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
451 has different meaning for each type:
452
453 (type) (konst)
454 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
455 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
456 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
457 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
458 */
459
460 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
461 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
462 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
463 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
464
465 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
466 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
467 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
468 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
469
470 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
471 loader for use by the static exception system. */
472
473 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
474 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
475 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
476 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
477 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
478 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
479 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
480 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
481 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
482 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
483 long reserved;
484 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
485 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
486 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
487 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
488
489 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
490 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, asection *,
491 bfd_vma, unsigned long, struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
492 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
493 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
494 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
495 (bfd_vma);
496 static bfd_boolean mips16_stub_section_p
497 (bfd *, asection *);
498 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
499 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
500 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
501 bfd_vma *, asection *);
502 static hashval_t mips_elf_got_entry_hash
503 (const void *);
504 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
505 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
506 static struct mips_got_info *mips_elf_got_for_ibfd
507 (struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
508
509 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
510 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
511
512 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
513 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
514 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
515
516 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
517 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
518 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
519
520 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
521 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
522
523 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
524 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
525 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
526
527 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
528 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
529 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
530
531 /* The name of the options section. */
532 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
533 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
534
535 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
536 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
537 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
538 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
539
540 /* Whether the section is readonly. */
541 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
542 ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)) \
543 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
544
545 /* The name of the stub section. */
546 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
547
548 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
549 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
550 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
551
552 /* The size of an external RELA relocation. */
553 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
554 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
555
556 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
557 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
558 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
559
560 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
561 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
562 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
563
564 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
565 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
566 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
567
568 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
569 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
570 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
571
572 /* Get word-sized data. */
573 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
574 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
575
576 /* Put out word-sized data. */
577 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
578 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
579 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
580 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
581
582 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
583 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
584 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
585
586 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
587 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (rtype, rela))
588
589 /* Determine whether the internal relocation of index REL_IDX is REL
590 (zero) or RELA (non-zero). The assumption is that, if there are
591 two relocation sections for this section, one of them is REL and
592 the other is RELA. If the index of the relocation we're testing is
593 in range for the first relocation section, check that the external
594 relocation size is that for RELA. It is also assumed that, if
595 rel_idx is not in range for the first section, and this first
596 section contains REL relocs, then the relocation is in the second
597 section, that is RELA. */
598 #define MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P(abfd, sec, rel_idx) \
599 ((NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (&elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr) \
600 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel \
601 > (bfd_vma)(rel_idx)) \
602 == (elf_section_data (sec)->rel_hdr.sh_entsize \
603 == (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? sizeof (Elf64_External_Rela) \
604 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela))))
605
606 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section. */
607 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
608 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
609
610 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
611 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
612 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
613 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
614
615 /* The number of local .got entries we reserve. */
616 #define MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO(INFO) \
617 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 3 : 2)
618
619 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
620 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
621 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
622
623 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
624 offsets from $gp. */
625 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
626
627 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
628 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
629 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
630 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
631 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
632 #define STUB_MOVE(abfd) \
633 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
634 ? 0x03e0782d /* daddu t7,ra */ \
635 : 0x03e07821)) /* addu t7,ra */
636 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
637 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr t9,ra */
638 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
639 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
640 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL) \
641 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
642 ? (0x64180000 + (VAL)) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
643 : (0x24180000 + (VAL)))) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
644
645 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
646 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
647
648 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
649 section. */
650
651 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
652 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
653 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
654 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
655
656 #ifdef BFD64
657 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
658 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
659 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
660 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
661 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
662 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
663 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
664 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
665 #else
666 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
667 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
668 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
669 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
670 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
671 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
672 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
673 #endif
674
675 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
676 floating point arguments.
677
678 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
679 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
680 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
681 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
682 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
683 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
684 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
685 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
686
687 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
688 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
689 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
690 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
691 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
692 stub should be discarded.
693
694 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
695 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
696 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
697 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
698 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
699 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
700 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
701 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
702
703 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
704 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
705 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
706
707 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
708
709 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
710 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
711 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
712
713 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
714 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
715 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
716
717 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable. */
718 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] = {
719 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
720 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
721 0x8f390008, /* lw t9, 8(t9) */
722 0x00000000, /* nop */
723 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
724 0x00000000 /* nop */
725 };
726
727 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
728 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] = {
729 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
730 0x24180000, /* li t8, <pltindex> */
731 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>) */
732 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>) */
733 0x8f390000, /* lw t9, 0(t9) */
734 0x00000000, /* nop */
735 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
736 0x00000000 /* nop */
737 };
738
739 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object. */
740 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] = {
741 0x8f990008, /* lw t9, 8(gp) */
742 0x00000000, /* nop */
743 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
744 0x00000000, /* nop */
745 0x00000000, /* nop */
746 0x00000000 /* nop */
747 };
748
749 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
750 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] = {
751 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
752 0x24180000 /* li t8, <pltindex> */
753 };
754
755 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
756
757 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
758 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
759 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
760 (copy), (follow)))
761
762 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
763
764 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
765 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
766 (&(table)->root, \
767 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
768 (info)))
769
770 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
771
772 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
773 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash))
774
775 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
776 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
777
778 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
779 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
780
781 static bfd_vma
dtprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)782 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
783 {
784 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
785 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
786 return 0;
787 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
788 }
789
790 static bfd_vma
tprel_base(struct bfd_link_info * info)791 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
792 {
793 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
794 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
795 return 0;
796 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
797 }
798
799 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
800
801 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc(struct bfd_hash_entry * entry,struct bfd_hash_table * table,const char * string)802 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
803 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
804 {
805 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
806 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
807
808 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
809 subclass. */
810 if (ret == NULL)
811 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
812 if (ret == NULL)
813 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
814
815 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
816 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
817 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
818 table, string));
819 if (ret != NULL)
820 {
821 /* Set local fields. */
822 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
823 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
824 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
825 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
826 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
827 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
828 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
829 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
830 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
831 ret->call_stub = NULL;
832 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
833 ret->forced_local = FALSE;
834 ret->is_branch_target = FALSE;
835 ret->is_relocation_target = FALSE;
836 ret->tls_type = GOT_NORMAL;
837 }
838
839 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
840 }
841
842 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)843 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
844 {
845 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
846 {
847 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
848 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
849
850 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
851 if (sdata == NULL)
852 return FALSE;
853 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
854 }
855
856 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
857 }
858
859 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
860 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
861
862 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info(bfd * abfd,asection * section,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)863 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
864 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
865 {
866 HDRR *symhdr;
867 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
868 char *ext_hdr;
869
870 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
871 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
872
873 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
874 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
875 goto error_return;
876
877 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
878 swap->external_hdr_size))
879 goto error_return;
880
881 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
882 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
883
884 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
885 read. */
886 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
887 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
888 debug->ptr = NULL; \
889 else \
890 { \
891 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
892 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
893 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
894 goto error_return; \
895 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
896 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
897 goto error_return; \
898 }
899
900 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
901 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
902 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
903 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
904 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
905 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
906 union aux_ext *);
907 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
908 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
909 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
910 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
911 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
912 #undef READ
913
914 debug->fdr = NULL;
915
916 return TRUE;
917
918 error_return:
919 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
920 free (ext_hdr);
921 if (debug->line != NULL)
922 free (debug->line);
923 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
924 free (debug->external_dnr);
925 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
926 free (debug->external_pdr);
927 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
928 free (debug->external_sym);
929 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
930 free (debug->external_opt);
931 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
932 free (debug->external_aux);
933 if (debug->ss != NULL)
934 free (debug->ss);
935 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
936 free (debug->ssext);
937 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
938 free (debug->external_fdr);
939 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
940 free (debug->external_rfd);
941 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
942 free (debug->external_ext);
943 return FALSE;
944 }
945
946 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
947
948 static void
ecoff_swap_rpdr_out(bfd * abfd,const RPDR * in,struct rpdr_ext * ex)949 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
950 {
951 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
952 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
953 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
954 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
955 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
956 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
957
958 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
959 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
960
961 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
962 }
963
964 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
965
966 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_procedure_table(void * handle,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * s,struct ecoff_debug_info * debug)967 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
968 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
969 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
970 {
971 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
972 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
973 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
974 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
975 void *rtproc;
976 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
977 struct sym_ext *esym;
978 char *ss, **sv;
979 char *str;
980 bfd_size_type size;
981 bfd_size_type count;
982 unsigned long sindex;
983 unsigned long i;
984 PDR pdr;
985 SYMR sym;
986 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
987
988 epdr = NULL;
989 rpdr = NULL;
990 esym = NULL;
991 ss = NULL;
992 sv = NULL;
993
994 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
995
996 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
997 count = hdr->ipdMax;
998 if (count > 0)
999 {
1000 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1001
1002 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1003 if (epdr == NULL)
1004 goto error_return;
1005
1006 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1007 goto error_return;
1008
1009 size = sizeof (RPDR);
1010 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1011 if (rpdr == NULL)
1012 goto error_return;
1013
1014 size = sizeof (char *);
1015 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1016 if (sv == NULL)
1017 goto error_return;
1018
1019 count = hdr->isymMax;
1020 size = swap->external_sym_size;
1021 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1022 if (esym == NULL)
1023 goto error_return;
1024
1025 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1026 goto error_return;
1027
1028 count = hdr->issMax;
1029 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1030 if (ss == NULL)
1031 goto error_return;
1032 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1033 goto error_return;
1034
1035 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1036 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1037 {
1038 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1039 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1040 rp->adr = sym.value;
1041 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1042 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1043 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1044 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1045 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1046 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1047 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1048 rp->irpss = sindex;
1049 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1050 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1051 }
1052 }
1053
1054 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1055 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1056 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1057 if (rtproc == NULL)
1058 {
1059 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1060 goto error_return;
1061 }
1062
1063 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1064
1065 erp = rtproc;
1066 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1067 erp++;
1068 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1069 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1070 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1071 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1072 {
1073 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1074 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1075 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1076 }
1077 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1078
1079 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
1080 s->size = size;
1081 s->contents = rtproc;
1082
1083 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1084 matters, but someday it might). */
1085 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1086
1087 if (epdr != NULL)
1088 free (epdr);
1089 if (rpdr != NULL)
1090 free (rpdr);
1091 if (esym != NULL)
1092 free (esym);
1093 if (ss != NULL)
1094 free (ss);
1095 if (sv != NULL)
1096 free (sv);
1097
1098 return TRUE;
1099
1100 error_return:
1101 if (epdr != NULL)
1102 free (epdr);
1103 if (rpdr != NULL)
1104 free (rpdr);
1105 if (esym != NULL)
1106 free (esym);
1107 if (ss != NULL)
1108 free (ss);
1109 if (sv != NULL)
1110 free (sv);
1111 return FALSE;
1112 }
1113
1114 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1115 discard them. */
1116
1117 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1118 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1119 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1120 {
1121 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1122 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1123
1124 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1125 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1126 {
1127 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1128 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1129 being included in the link. */
1130 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1131 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1132 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1133 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1134 }
1135
1136 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1137 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1138 {
1139 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1140 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1141 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1142 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1143 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1144 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1145 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1146 }
1147
1148 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1149 && h->root.other == STO_MIPS16)
1150 {
1151 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1152 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1153 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1154 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1155 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1156 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1157 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1158 }
1159
1160 return TRUE;
1161 }
1162
1163 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
1164 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
1165 are 32 bits.
1166
1167 The format of these instructions is:
1168
1169 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1170 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
1171 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1172 | Immediate 15:0 |
1173 +-----------------------------------------------+
1174
1175 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
1176 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
1177
1178 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
1179 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
1180 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
1181 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
1182 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
1183 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
1184 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
1185 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
1186 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
1187 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
1188 instruction.
1189
1190 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
1191 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
1192 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
1193 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
1194 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
1195 value as two 16-bit values.
1196
1197 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
1198 defined as
1199
1200 big-endian:
1201 +--------+----------------------+
1202 | | |
1203 | | targ26-16 |
1204 |31 26|25 0|
1205 +--------+----------------------+
1206
1207 little-endian:
1208 +----------+------+-------------+
1209 | | | |
1210 | sub1 | | sub2 |
1211 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
1212 +----------+--------------------+
1213 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
1214 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
1215
1216 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
1217 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1218 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
1219 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
1220 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
1221
1222 R_MIPS16_GPREL is used for GP-relative addressing in mips16
1223 mode. A typical instruction will have a format like this:
1224
1225 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1226 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
1227 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1228 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
1229 +--------------+--------------------------------+
1230
1231 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
1232 opcode.
1233
1234 This is handled exactly like R_MIPS_GPREL16, except that the
1235 addend is retrieved and stored as shown in this diagram; that
1236 is, the Imm fields above replace the V-rel16 field.
1237
1238 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately. As
1239 above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
1240 little-endian system.
1241
1242 R_MIPS16_HI16 and R_MIPS16_LO16 are used in mips16 mode to
1243 access data when neither GP-relative nor PC-relative addressing
1244 can be used. They are handled like R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16,
1245 except that the addend is retrieved and stored as shown above
1246 for R_MIPS16_GPREL.
1247 */
1248 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1249 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1250 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1251 {
1252 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1253
1254 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1255 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1256 return;
1257
1258 /* Pick up the mips16 extend instruction and the real instruction. */
1259 extend = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
1260 insn = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
1261 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1262 {
1263 if (jal_shuffle)
1264 val = ((extend & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((extend & 0x3e0) << 11)
1265 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 21) | insn;
1266 else
1267 val = extend << 16 | insn;
1268 }
1269 else
1270 val = ((extend & 0xf800) << 16) | ((insn & 0xffe0) << 11)
1271 | ((extend & 0x1f) << 11) | (extend & 0x7e0) | (insn & 0x1f);
1272 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
1273 }
1274
1275 void
_bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(bfd * abfd,int r_type,bfd_boolean jal_shuffle,bfd_byte * data)1276 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
1277 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
1278 {
1279 bfd_vma extend, insn, val;
1280
1281 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && r_type != R_MIPS16_GPREL
1282 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
1283 return;
1284
1285 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
1286 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
1287 {
1288 if (jal_shuffle)
1289 {
1290 insn = val & 0xffff;
1291 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
1292 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
1293 }
1294 else
1295 {
1296 insn = val & 0xffff;
1297 extend = val >> 16;
1298 }
1299 }
1300 else
1301 {
1302 insn = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
1303 extend = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
1304 }
1305 bfd_put_16 (abfd, insn, data + 2);
1306 bfd_put_16 (abfd, extend, data);
1307 }
1308
1309 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp(bfd * abfd,asymbol * symbol,arelent * reloc_entry,asection * input_section,bfd_boolean relocatable,void * data,bfd_vma gp)1310 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1311 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
1312 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
1313 {
1314 bfd_vma relocation;
1315 bfd_signed_vma val;
1316 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1317
1318 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1319 relocation = 0;
1320 else
1321 relocation = symbol->value;
1322
1323 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1324 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
1325
1326 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1327 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1328
1329 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
1330 val = reloc_entry->addend;
1331
1332 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
1333
1334 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
1335 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
1336 an external symbol. */
1337 if (! relocatable
1338 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1339 val += relocation - gp;
1340
1341 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1342 {
1343 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1344 (bfd_byte *) data
1345 + reloc_entry->address);
1346 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1347 return status;
1348 }
1349 else
1350 reloc_entry->addend = val;
1351
1352 if (relocatable)
1353 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1354
1355 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1356 }
1357
1358 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
1359 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
1360 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
1361 INPUT_SECTION. */
1362
1363 struct mips_hi16
1364 {
1365 struct mips_hi16 *next;
1366 bfd_byte *data;
1367 asection *input_section;
1368 arelent rel;
1369 };
1370
1371 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
1372
1373 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
1374
1375 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
1376 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
1377 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
1378
1379 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
1380 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
1381 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
1382 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
1383
1384 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1385 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1386 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
1387 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1388 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1389 {
1390 struct mips_hi16 *n;
1391
1392 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1393 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1394
1395 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
1396 if (n == NULL)
1397 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1398
1399 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
1400 n->data = data;
1401 n->input_section = input_section;
1402 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
1403 mips_hi16_list = n;
1404
1405 if (output_bfd != NULL)
1406 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1407
1408 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1409 }
1410
1411 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations. This is just
1412 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
1413 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
1414
1415 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1416 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1417 void *data, asection *input_section,
1418 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1419 {
1420 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
1421 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
1422 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
1423 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
1424 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1425 input_section, output_bfd,
1426 error_message);
1427
1428 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1429 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
1430 }
1431
1432 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
1433 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
1434 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
1435
1436 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc(bfd * abfd,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message)1437 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
1438 void *data, asection *input_section,
1439 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
1440 {
1441 bfd_vma vallo;
1442 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1443
1444 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1445 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1446
1447 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1448 location);
1449 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
1450 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1451 location);
1452
1453 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
1454 {
1455 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
1456 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
1457
1458 hi = mips_hi16_list;
1459
1460 /* R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
1461 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS_HI16
1462 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
1463 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
1464 has a rightshift of 0. */
1465 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
1466 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
1467
1468 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
1469 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
1470 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
1471
1472 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
1473 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
1474 error_message);
1475 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
1476 return ret;
1477
1478 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
1479 free (hi);
1480 }
1481
1482 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
1483 input_section, output_bfd,
1484 error_message);
1485 }
1486
1487 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
1488 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
1489 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
1490
1491 bfd_reloc_status_type
_bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,arelent * reloc_entry,asymbol * symbol,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * input_section,bfd * output_bfd,char ** error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1492 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
1493 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1494 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
1495 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1496 {
1497 bfd_signed_vma val;
1498 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
1499 bfd_boolean relocatable;
1500
1501 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
1502
1503 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
1504 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
1505
1506 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
1507 val = 0;
1508 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
1509 {
1510 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
1511 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
1512 offset or address. */
1513 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
1514 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
1515 }
1516
1517 if (!relocatable)
1518 {
1519 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
1520 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
1521 val += symbol->value;
1522 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
1523 {
1524 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
1525 val -= input_section->output_offset;
1526 val -= reloc_entry->address;
1527 }
1528 }
1529
1530 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
1531 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
1532 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
1533 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
1534 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
1535 reloc_entry->addend += val;
1536 else
1537 {
1538 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
1539
1540 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
1541 val += reloc_entry->addend;
1542
1543 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
1544 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1545 location);
1546 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
1547 location);
1548 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
1549 location);
1550
1551 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
1552 return status;
1553 }
1554
1555 if (relocatable)
1556 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1557
1558 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1559 }
1560
1561 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
1562 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
1563
1564 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_gptab * ex,Elf32_gptab * in)1565 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
1566 Elf32_gptab *in)
1567 {
1568 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1569 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1570 }
1571
1572 static void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_gptab * in,Elf32_External_gptab * ex)1573 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
1574 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
1575 {
1576 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
1577 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
1578 }
1579
1580 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_compact_rel * in,Elf32_External_compact_rel * ex)1581 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
1582 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
1583 {
1584 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
1585 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
1586 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
1587 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
1588 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
1589 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
1590 }
1591
1592 static void
bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_crinfo * in,Elf32_External_crinfo * ex)1593 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
1594 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
1595 {
1596 unsigned long l;
1597
1598 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
1599 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
1600 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
1601 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
1602 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
1603 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
1604 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
1605 }
1606
1607 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
1608 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
1609 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
1610
1611 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf32_RegInfo * in)1612 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
1613 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
1614 {
1615 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1616 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1617 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1618 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1619 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1620 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1621 }
1622
1623 void
bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf32_RegInfo * in,Elf32_External_RegInfo * ex)1624 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
1625 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
1626 {
1627 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1628 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1629 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1630 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1631 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1632 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1633 }
1634
1635 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
1636 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
1637 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
1638 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
1639 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
1640
1641 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex,Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in)1642 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
1643 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
1644 {
1645 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
1646 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
1647 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1648 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1649 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1650 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1651 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
1652 }
1653
1654 void
bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo * in,Elf64_External_RegInfo * ex)1655 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
1656 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
1657 {
1658 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
1659 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
1660 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
1661 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
1662 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
1663 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
1664 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
1665 }
1666
1667 /* Swap in an options header. */
1668
1669 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in(bfd * abfd,const Elf_External_Options * ex,Elf_Internal_Options * in)1670 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
1671 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
1672 {
1673 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
1674 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
1675 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
1676 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
1677 }
1678
1679 /* Swap out an options header. */
1680
1681 void
bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out(bfd * abfd,const Elf_Internal_Options * in,Elf_External_Options * ex)1682 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
1683 Elf_External_Options *ex)
1684 {
1685 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
1686 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
1687 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
1688 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
1689 }
1690
1691 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
1692 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
1693
1694 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs(const void * arg1,const void * arg2)1695 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
1696 {
1697 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
1698 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
1699 int diff;
1700
1701 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
1702 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
1703
1704 diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
1705 if (diff != 0)
1706 return diff;
1707
1708 if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
1709 return -1;
1710 if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
1711 return 1;
1712 return 0;
1713 }
1714
1715 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
1716
1717 static int
sort_dynamic_relocs_64(const void * arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const void * arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)1718 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1719 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1720 {
1721 #ifdef BFD64
1722 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
1723 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
1724
1725 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1726 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
1727 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
1728 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
1729
1730 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1731 return -1;
1732 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
1733 return 1;
1734
1735 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1736 return -1;
1737 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
1738 return 1;
1739 return 0;
1740 #else
1741 abort ();
1742 #endif
1743 }
1744
1745
1746 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
1747 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
1748 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
1749 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
1750 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
1751 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
1752 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
1753 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
1754 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
1755 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
1756 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
1757 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
1758 when generating a final executable. */
1759
1760 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_output_extsym(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)1761 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
1762 {
1763 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
1764 bfd_boolean strip;
1765 asection *sec, *output_section;
1766
1767 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
1768 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
1769
1770 if (h->root.indx == -2)
1771 strip = FALSE;
1772 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
1773 || h->root.ref_dynamic
1774 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
1775 && !h->root.def_regular
1776 && !h->root.ref_regular)
1777 strip = TRUE;
1778 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
1779 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
1780 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
1781 h->root.root.root.string,
1782 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
1783 strip = TRUE;
1784 else
1785 strip = FALSE;
1786
1787 if (strip)
1788 return TRUE;
1789
1790 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
1791 {
1792 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
1793 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
1794 h->esym.weakext = 0;
1795 h->esym.reserved = 0;
1796 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
1797 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1798 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
1799
1800 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
1801 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
1802 {
1803 const char *name;
1804
1805 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
1806 special symbols. */
1807 name = h->root.root.root.string;
1808 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
1809 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
1810 {
1811 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1812 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1813 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1814 }
1815 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
1816 {
1817 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1818 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1819 h->esym.asym.value =
1820 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
1821 }
1822 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (einfo->abfd))
1823 {
1824 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1825 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
1826 h->esym.asym.value = elf_gp (einfo->abfd);
1827 }
1828 else
1829 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1830 }
1831 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
1832 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1833 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1834 else
1835 {
1836 const char *name;
1837
1838 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1839 output_section = sec->output_section;
1840
1841 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
1842 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
1843 if (output_section == NULL)
1844 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
1845 else
1846 {
1847 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
1848
1849 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
1850 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
1851 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
1852 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
1853 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
1854 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
1855 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
1856 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
1857 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
1858 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
1859 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1860 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
1861 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1862 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
1863 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
1864 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
1865 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
1866 else
1867 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
1868 }
1869 }
1870
1871 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
1872 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
1873 }
1874
1875 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
1876 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
1877 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1878 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1879 {
1880 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
1881 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
1882 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
1883 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
1884
1885 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1886 output_section = sec->output_section;
1887 if (output_section != NULL)
1888 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
1889 + sec->output_offset
1890 + output_section->vma);
1891 else
1892 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1893 }
1894 else if (h->root.needs_plt)
1895 {
1896 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
1897 bfd_boolean no_fn_stub = h->no_fn_stub;
1898
1899 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
1900 {
1901 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
1902 no_fn_stub = no_fn_stub || hd->no_fn_stub;
1903 }
1904
1905 if (!no_fn_stub)
1906 {
1907 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
1908 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
1909 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
1910 if (sec == NULL)
1911 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1912 else
1913 {
1914 output_section = sec->output_section;
1915 if (output_section != NULL)
1916 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.offset
1917 + sec->output_offset
1918 + output_section->vma);
1919 else
1920 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
1921 }
1922 }
1923 }
1924
1925 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
1926 h->root.root.root.string,
1927 &h->esym))
1928 {
1929 einfo->failed = TRUE;
1930 return FALSE;
1931 }
1932
1933 return TRUE;
1934 }
1935
1936 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
1937
1938 static int
gptab_compare(const void * p1,const void * p2)1939 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
1940 {
1941 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
1942 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
1943
1944 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
1945 }
1946
1947 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
1948
1949 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
1950 hash number. */
1951
1952 static INLINE hashval_t
mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma(bfd_vma addr)1953 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
1954 {
1955 #ifdef BFD64
1956 return addr + (addr >> 32);
1957 #else
1958 return addr;
1959 #endif
1960 }
1961
1962 /* got_entries only match if they're identical, except for gotidx, so
1963 use all fields to compute the hash, and compare the appropriate
1964 union members. */
1965
1966 static hashval_t
mips_elf_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)1967 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
1968 {
1969 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
1970
1971 return entry->symndx
1972 + ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) << 17)
1973 + (! entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
1974 : entry->abfd->id
1975 + (entry->symndx >= 0 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)
1976 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
1977 }
1978
1979 static int
mips_elf_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)1980 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
1981 {
1982 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
1983 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
1984
1985 /* An LDM entry can only match another LDM entry. */
1986 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
1987 return 0;
1988
1989 return e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->symndx == e2->symndx
1990 && (! e1->abfd ? e1->d.address == e2->d.address
1991 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
1992 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
1993 }
1994
1995 /* multi_got_entries are still a match in the case of global objects,
1996 even if the input bfd in which they're referenced differs, so the
1997 hash computation and compare functions are adjusted
1998 accordingly. */
1999
2000 static hashval_t
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2001 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2002 {
2003 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
2004
2005 return entry->symndx
2006 + (! entry->abfd
2007 ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
2008 : entry->symndx >= 0
2009 ? ((entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2010 ? (GOT_TLS_LDM << 17)
2011 : (entry->abfd->id
2012 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend)))
2013 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash);
2014 }
2015
2016 static int
mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2017 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2018 {
2019 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
2020 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
2021
2022 /* Any two LDM entries match. */
2023 if (e1->tls_type & e2->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2024 return 1;
2025
2026 /* Nothing else matches an LDM entry. */
2027 if ((e1->tls_type ^ e2->tls_type) & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2028 return 0;
2029
2030 return e1->symndx == e2->symndx
2031 && (e1->symndx >= 0 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend
2032 : e1->abfd == NULL || e2->abfd == NULL
2033 ? e1->abfd == e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
2034 : e1->d.h == e2->d.h);
2035 }
2036
2037 /* Return the dynamic relocation section. If it doesn't exist, try to
2038 create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL. Also return NULL
2039 if creation fails. */
2040
2041 static asection *
mips_elf_rel_dyn_section(struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean create_p)2042 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
2043 {
2044 const char *dname;
2045 asection *sreloc;
2046 bfd *dynobj;
2047
2048 dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
2049 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2050 sreloc = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, dname);
2051 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
2052 {
2053 sreloc = bfd_make_section_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
2054 (SEC_ALLOC
2055 | SEC_LOAD
2056 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2057 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2058 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
2059 | SEC_READONLY));
2060 if (sreloc == NULL
2061 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
2062 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
2063 return NULL;
2064 }
2065 return sreloc;
2066 }
2067
2068 /* Returns the GOT section for ABFD. */
2069
2070 static asection *
mips_elf_got_section(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)2071 mips_elf_got_section (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean maybe_excluded)
2072 {
2073 asection *sgot = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
2074 if (sgot == NULL
2075 || (! maybe_excluded && (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0))
2076 return NULL;
2077 return sgot;
2078 }
2079
2080 /* Returns the GOT information associated with the link indicated by
2081 INFO. If SGOTP is non-NULL, it is filled in with the GOT
2082 section. */
2083
2084 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_info(bfd * abfd,asection ** sgotp)2085 mips_elf_got_info (bfd *abfd, asection **sgotp)
2086 {
2087 asection *sgot;
2088 struct mips_got_info *g;
2089
2090 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
2091 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
2092 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
2093 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
2094 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2095
2096 if (sgotp)
2097 *sgotp = (sgot->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0 ? sgot : NULL;
2098
2099 return g;
2100 }
2101
2102 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
2103 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
2104 is NULL). */
2105
2106 static int
mips_tls_got_relocs(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned char tls_type,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2107 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
2108 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2109 {
2110 int indx = 0;
2111 int ret = 0;
2112 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2113 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2114
2115 if (h && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, h)
2116 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
2117 indx = h->dynindx;
2118
2119 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2120 && (h == NULL
2121 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
2122 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2123 need_relocs = TRUE;
2124
2125 if (!need_relocs)
2126 return FALSE;
2127
2128 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2129 {
2130 ret++;
2131 if (indx != 0)
2132 ret++;
2133 }
2134
2135 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2136 ret++;
2137
2138 if ((tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM) && info->shared)
2139 ret++;
2140
2141 return ret;
2142 }
2143
2144 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the GOT entry in
2145 ARG1, if it describes a local symbol. */
2146
2147 static int
mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs(void ** arg1,void * arg2)2148 mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs (void **arg1, void *arg2)
2149 {
2150 struct mips_got_entry *entry = * (struct mips_got_entry **) arg1;
2151 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2152
2153 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx != -1)
2154 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type, NULL);
2155
2156 return 1;
2157 }
2158
2159 /* Count the number of TLS GOT entries required for the global (or
2160 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2161
2162 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries(void * arg1,void * arg2)2163 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2164 {
2165 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2166 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2167 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2168
2169 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2170 arg->needed += 2;
2171 if (hm->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
2172 arg->needed += 1;
2173
2174 return 1;
2175 }
2176
2177 /* Count the number of TLS relocations required for the global (or
2178 forced-local) symbol in ARG1. */
2179
2180 static int
mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs(void * arg1,void * arg2)2181 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs (void *arg1, void *arg2)
2182 {
2183 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2184 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) arg1;
2185 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg *arg = arg2;
2186
2187 arg->needed += mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, hm->tls_type, &hm->root);
2188
2189 return 1;
2190 }
2191
2192 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
2193
2194 static void
mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,asection * sreloc,unsigned long indx,int r_type,bfd_vma offset)2195 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
2196 asection *sreloc,
2197 unsigned long indx,
2198 int r_type,
2199 bfd_vma offset)
2200 {
2201 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
2202
2203 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
2204
2205 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
2206 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
2207
2208 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
2209 {
2210 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
2211 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2212 (sreloc->contents
2213 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
2214 }
2215 else
2216 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
2217 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
2218 (sreloc->contents
2219 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
2220 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
2221 }
2222
2223 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
2224
2225 static void
mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_offset,unsigned char * tls_type_p,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma value)2226 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_offset,
2227 unsigned char *tls_type_p,
2228 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2229 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2230 bfd_vma value)
2231 {
2232 int indx;
2233 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
2234 bfd_vma offset, offset2;
2235 bfd *dynobj;
2236 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
2237
2238 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2239 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
2240
2241 indx = 0;
2242 if (h != NULL)
2243 {
2244 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
2245
2246 if (WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, info->shared, &h->root)
2247 && (!info->shared || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
2248 indx = h->root.dynindx;
2249 }
2250
2251 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_DONE)
2252 return;
2253
2254 if ((info->shared || indx != 0)
2255 && (h == NULL
2256 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
2257 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
2258 need_relocs = TRUE;
2259
2260 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
2261 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
2262 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
2263 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
2264 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
2265
2266 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
2267 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2268
2269 /* General Dynamic. */
2270 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_GD)
2271 {
2272 offset = got_offset;
2273 offset2 = offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2274
2275 if (need_relocs)
2276 {
2277 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2278 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2279 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2280 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2281
2282 if (indx)
2283 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2284 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2285 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
2286 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset2);
2287 else
2288 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2289 sgot->contents + offset2);
2290 }
2291 else
2292 {
2293 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2294 sgot->contents + offset);
2295 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
2296 sgot->contents + offset2);
2297 }
2298
2299 got_offset += 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2300 }
2301
2302 /* Initial Exec model. */
2303 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_IE)
2304 {
2305 offset = got_offset;
2306
2307 if (need_relocs)
2308 {
2309 if (indx == 0)
2310 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
2311 sgot->contents + offset);
2312 else
2313 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2314 sgot->contents + offset);
2315
2316 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2317 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2318 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
2319 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + offset);
2320 }
2321 else
2322 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
2323 sgot->contents + offset);
2324 }
2325
2326 if (*tls_type_p & GOT_TLS_LDM)
2327 {
2328 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
2329 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
2330 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
2331 sgot->contents + got_offset
2332 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2333
2334 if (!info->shared)
2335 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
2336 sgot->contents + got_offset);
2337 else
2338 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
2339 (abfd, sreloc, indx,
2340 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
2341 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
2342 }
2343
2344 *tls_type_p |= GOT_TLS_DONE;
2345 }
2346
2347 /* Return the GOT index to use for a relocation of type R_TYPE against
2348 a symbol accessed using TLS_TYPE models. The GOT entries for this
2349 symbol in this GOT start at GOT_INDEX. This function initializes the
2350 GOT entries and corresponding relocations. */
2351
2352 static bfd_vma
mips_tls_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd_vma got_index,unsigned char * tls_type,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd_vma symbol)2353 mips_tls_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd_vma got_index, unsigned char *tls_type,
2354 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2355 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, bfd_vma symbol)
2356 {
2357 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2358 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM);
2359
2360 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, got_index, tls_type, info, h, symbol);
2361
2362 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL)
2363 {
2364 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE);
2365 if (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD)
2366 return got_index + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
2367 else
2368 return got_index;
2369 }
2370
2371 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD)
2372 {
2373 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD);
2374 return got_index;
2375 }
2376
2377 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2378 {
2379 BFD_ASSERT (*tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM);
2380 return got_index;
2381 }
2382
2383 return got_index;
2384 }
2385
2386 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
2387 for global symbol H. .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
2388 will be negative. */
2389
2390 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_gotplt_index(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)2391 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2392 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
2393 {
2394 bfd_vma plt_index, got_address, got_value;
2395 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2396
2397 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2398 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1);
2399
2400 /* Calculate the index of the symbol's PLT entry. */
2401 plt_index = (h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size) / htab->plt_entry_size;
2402
2403 /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry. */
2404 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
2405 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
2406 + plt_index * 4);
2407
2408 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
2409 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
2410 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2411 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
2412
2413 return got_address - got_value;
2414 }
2415
2416 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE. If there is not yet a GOT
2417 entry for this value, create one. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
2418 create a TLS GOT entry instead. Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
2419 offset can be found. */
2420
2421 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_local_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2422 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2423 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
2424 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
2425 {
2426 asection *sgot;
2427 struct mips_got_info *g;
2428 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2429
2430 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2431
2432 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2433 value, r_symndx, h, r_type);
2434 if (!entry)
2435 return MINUS_ONE;
2436
2437 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2438 {
2439 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
2440 /* A type (3) entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
2441 hash table entry to track the index. */
2442 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, h->tls_got_offset, &h->tls_type,
2443 r_type, info, h, value);
2444 else
2445 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, entry->gotidx, &entry->tls_type,
2446 r_type, info, h, value);
2447 }
2448 else
2449 return entry->gotidx;
2450 }
2451
2452 /* Returns the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H. */
2453
2454 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_global_got_index(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type,struct bfd_link_info * info)2455 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2456 int r_type, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2457 {
2458 bfd_vma index;
2459 asection *sgot;
2460 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
2461 long global_got_dynindx = 0;
2462
2463 gg = g = mips_elf_got_info (abfd, &sgot);
2464 if (g->bfd2got && ibfd)
2465 {
2466 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
2467
2468 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= 0);
2469
2470 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
2471 if (g->next != gg || TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2472 {
2473 e.abfd = ibfd;
2474 e.symndx = -1;
2475 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
2476 e.tls_type = 0;
2477
2478 p = htab_find (g->got_entries, &e);
2479
2480 BFD_ASSERT (p->gotidx > 0);
2481
2482 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2483 {
2484 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2485 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2486 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2487 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2488 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2489 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2490 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2491
2492 return mips_tls_got_index (abfd, p->gotidx, &p->tls_type, r_type,
2493 info, e.d.h, value);
2494 }
2495 else
2496 return p->gotidx;
2497 }
2498 }
2499
2500 if (gg->global_gotsym != NULL)
2501 global_got_dynindx = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
2502
2503 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2504 {
2505 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hm
2506 = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2507 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
2508
2509 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
2510 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2511 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
2512 value = (h->root.u.def.value
2513 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
2514 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
2515
2516 index = mips_tls_got_index (abfd, hm->tls_got_offset, &hm->tls_type,
2517 r_type, info, hm, value);
2518 }
2519 else
2520 {
2521 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
2522 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
2523 indices into the GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the GOT
2524 offset. */
2525 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
2526 index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
2527 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
2528 }
2529 BFD_ASSERT (index < sgot->size);
2530
2531 return index;
2532 }
2533
2534 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE. These
2535 entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
2536 within 32KB of GP. Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
2537 entry could be created. If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
2538 offset of the GOT entry from VALUE. */
2539
2540 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_page(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_vma * offsetp)2541 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2542 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
2543 {
2544 asection *sgot;
2545 struct mips_got_info *g;
2546 bfd_vma page, index;
2547 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2548
2549 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2550
2551 page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
2552 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2553 page, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
2554
2555 if (!entry)
2556 return MINUS_ONE;
2557
2558 index = entry->gotidx;
2559
2560 if (offsetp)
2561 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
2562
2563 return index;
2564 }
2565
2566 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
2567 EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was against a global symbol
2568 that has been forced local. */
2569
2570 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got16_entry(bfd * abfd,bfd * ibfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_vma value,bfd_boolean external)2571 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2572 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
2573 {
2574 asection *sgot;
2575 struct mips_got_info *g;
2576 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
2577
2578 /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
2579 relocation; those against global symbols are not. Thus if the
2580 symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
2581 equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself. */
2582 if (! external)
2583 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
2584
2585 g = mips_elf_got_info (elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj, &sgot);
2586
2587 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, g, sgot,
2588 value, 0, NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
2589 if (entry)
2590 return entry->gotidx;
2591 else
2592 return MINUS_ONE;
2593 }
2594
2595 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
2596 in the GOT. */
2597
2598 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_got_offset_from_index(bfd * dynobj,bfd * output_bfd,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_vma index)2599 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (bfd *dynobj, bfd *output_bfd,
2600 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma index)
2601 {
2602 asection *sgot;
2603 bfd_vma gp;
2604 struct mips_got_info *g;
2605
2606 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
2607 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
2608 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, g, input_bfd);
2609
2610 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + index - gp;
2611 }
2612
2613 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
2614 from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON. Return NULL if it could not
2615 be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
2616 instead. */
2617
2618 static struct mips_got_entry *
mips_elf_create_local_got_entry(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * ibfd,struct mips_got_info * gg,asection * sgot,bfd_vma value,unsigned long r_symndx,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,int r_type)2619 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2620 bfd *ibfd, struct mips_got_info *gg,
2621 asection *sgot, bfd_vma value,
2622 unsigned long r_symndx,
2623 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2624 int r_type)
2625 {
2626 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2627 struct mips_got_info *g;
2628 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2629
2630 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2631
2632 entry.abfd = NULL;
2633 entry.symndx = -1;
2634 entry.d.address = value;
2635 entry.tls_type = 0;
2636
2637 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, ibfd);
2638 if (g == NULL)
2639 {
2640 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, abfd);
2641 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2642 }
2643
2644 /* We might have a symbol, H, if it has been forced local. Use the
2645 global entry then. It doesn't matter whether an entry is local
2646 or global for TLS, since the dynamic linker does not
2647 automatically relocate TLS GOT entries. */
2648 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->root.forced_local);
2649 if (TLS_RELOC_P (r_type))
2650 {
2651 struct mips_got_entry *p;
2652
2653 entry.abfd = ibfd;
2654 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
2655 {
2656 entry.tls_type = GOT_TLS_LDM;
2657 entry.symndx = 0;
2658 entry.d.addend = 0;
2659 }
2660 else if (h == NULL)
2661 {
2662 entry.symndx = r_symndx;
2663 entry.d.addend = 0;
2664 }
2665 else
2666 entry.d.h = h;
2667
2668 p = (struct mips_got_entry *)
2669 htab_find (g->got_entries, &entry);
2670
2671 BFD_ASSERT (p);
2672 return p;
2673 }
2674
2675 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2676 INSERT);
2677 if (*loc)
2678 return *loc;
2679
2680 entry.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_gotno++;
2681 entry.tls_type = 0;
2682
2683 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2684
2685 if (! *loc)
2686 return NULL;
2687
2688 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2689
2690 if (g->assigned_gotno >= g->local_gotno)
2691 {
2692 (*loc)->gotidx = -1;
2693 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
2694 (*_bfd_error_handler)
2695 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
2696 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2697 return NULL;
2698 }
2699
2700 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value,
2701 (sgot->contents + entry.gotidx));
2702
2703 /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks. */
2704 if (htab->is_vxworks)
2705 {
2706 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
2707 asection *s;
2708 bfd_byte *loc;
2709 bfd_vma got_address;
2710
2711 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
2712 got_address = (sgot->output_section->vma
2713 + sgot->output_offset
2714 + entry.gotidx);
2715
2716 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
2717 outrel.r_offset = got_address;
2718 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
2719 outrel.r_addend = value;
2720 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
2721 }
2722
2723 return *loc;
2724 }
2725
2726 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
2727 appear towards the end. This reduces the amount of GOT space
2728 required. MAX_LOCAL is used to set the number of local symbols
2729 known to be in the dynamic symbol table. During
2730 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections, this value is 1. Afterward, the
2731 section symbols are added and the count is higher. */
2732
2733 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table(struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned long max_local)2734 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned long max_local)
2735 {
2736 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
2737 struct mips_got_info *g;
2738 bfd *dynobj;
2739
2740 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
2741
2742 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
2743
2744 hsd.low = NULL;
2745 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx =
2746 hsd.min_got_dynindx = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
2747 /* In the multi-got case, assigned_gotno of the master got_info
2748 indicate the number of entries that aren't referenced in the
2749 primary GOT, but that must have entries because there are
2750 dynamic relocations that reference it. Since they aren't
2751 referenced, we move them to the end of the GOT, so that they
2752 don't prevent other entries that are referenced from getting
2753 too large offsets. */
2754 - (g->next ? g->assigned_gotno : 0);
2755 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = max_local;
2756 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *)
2757 elf_hash_table (info)),
2758 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f,
2759 &hsd);
2760
2761 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
2762 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
2763 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
2764 BFD_ASSERT ((unsigned long)hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
2765 <= elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount);
2766
2767 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
2768 table index in the GOT. */
2769 g->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
2770
2771 return TRUE;
2772 }
2773
2774 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
2775 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
2776 index. */
2777
2778 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f(struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,void * data)2779 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2780 {
2781 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
2782
2783 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2784 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
2785
2786 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
2787 at all. */
2788 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
2789 return TRUE;
2790
2791 /* Global symbols that need GOT entries that are not explicitly
2792 referenced are marked with got offset 2. Those that are
2793 referenced get a 1, and those that don't need GOT entries get
2794 -1. */
2795 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
2796 {
2797 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2798
2799 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
2800 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2801 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
2802 }
2803 else if (h->root.got.offset != 1)
2804 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
2805 else
2806 {
2807 BFD_ASSERT (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL);
2808
2809 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
2810 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2811 }
2812
2813 return TRUE;
2814 }
2815
2816 /* If H is a symbol that needs a global GOT entry, but has a dynamic
2817 symbol table index lower than any we've seen to date, record it for
2818 posterity. */
2819
2820 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2821 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2822 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
2823 struct mips_got_info *g,
2824 unsigned char tls_flag)
2825 {
2826 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2827
2828 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
2829 table. */
2830 if (h->dynindx == -1)
2831 {
2832 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
2833 {
2834 case STV_INTERNAL:
2835 case STV_HIDDEN:
2836 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
2837 break;
2838 }
2839 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
2840 return FALSE;
2841 }
2842
2843 /* Make sure we have a GOT to put this entry into. */
2844 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
2845
2846 entry.abfd = abfd;
2847 entry.symndx = -1;
2848 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2849 entry.tls_type = 0;
2850
2851 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **) htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry,
2852 INSERT);
2853
2854 /* If we've already marked this entry as needing GOT space, we don't
2855 need to do it again. */
2856 if (*loc)
2857 {
2858 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2859 return TRUE;
2860 }
2861
2862 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2863
2864 if (! *loc)
2865 return FALSE;
2866
2867 entry.gotidx = -1;
2868 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2869
2870 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2871
2872 if (h->got.offset != MINUS_ONE)
2873 return TRUE;
2874
2875 /* By setting this to a value other than -1, we are indicating that
2876 there needs to be a GOT entry for H. Avoid using zero, as the
2877 generic ELF copy_indirect_symbol tests for <= 0. */
2878 if (tls_flag == 0)
2879 h->got.offset = 1;
2880
2881 return TRUE;
2882 }
2883
2884 /* Reserve space in G for a GOT entry containing the value of symbol
2885 SYMNDX in input bfd ABDF, plus ADDEND. */
2886
2887 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol(bfd * abfd,long symndx,bfd_vma addend,struct mips_got_info * g,unsigned char tls_flag)2888 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
2889 struct mips_got_info *g,
2890 unsigned char tls_flag)
2891 {
2892 struct mips_got_entry entry, **loc;
2893
2894 entry.abfd = abfd;
2895 entry.symndx = symndx;
2896 entry.d.addend = addend;
2897 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2898 loc = (struct mips_got_entry **)
2899 htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &entry, INSERT);
2900
2901 if (*loc)
2902 {
2903 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_GD))
2904 {
2905 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2906 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2907 }
2908 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE && !((*loc)->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE))
2909 {
2910 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2911 (*loc)->tls_type |= tls_flag;
2912 }
2913 return TRUE;
2914 }
2915
2916 if (tls_flag != 0)
2917 {
2918 entry.gotidx = -1;
2919 entry.tls_type = tls_flag;
2920 if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_IE)
2921 g->tls_gotno += 1;
2922 else if (tls_flag == GOT_TLS_GD)
2923 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2924 else if (g->tls_ldm_offset == MINUS_ONE)
2925 {
2926 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_TWO;
2927 g->tls_gotno += 2;
2928 }
2929 }
2930 else
2931 {
2932 entry.gotidx = g->local_gotno++;
2933 entry.tls_type = 0;
2934 }
2935
2936 *loc = (struct mips_got_entry *)bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof entry);
2937
2938 if (! *loc)
2939 return FALSE;
2940
2941 memcpy (*loc, &entry, sizeof entry);
2942
2943 return TRUE;
2944 }
2945
2946 /* Compute the hash value of the bfd in a bfd2got hash entry. */
2947
2948 static hashval_t
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash(const void * entry_)2949 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
2950 {
2951 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *entry
2952 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry_;
2953
2954 return entry->bfd->id;
2955 }
2956
2957 /* Check whether two hash entries have the same bfd. */
2958
2959 static int
mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq(const void * entry1,const void * entry2)2960 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
2961 {
2962 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e1
2963 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry1;
2964 const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *e2
2965 = (const struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)entry2;
2966
2967 return e1->bfd == e2->bfd;
2968 }
2969
2970 /* In a multi-got link, determine the GOT to be used for IBFD. G must
2971 be the master GOT data. */
2972
2973 static struct mips_got_info *
mips_elf_got_for_ibfd(struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)2974 mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
2975 {
2976 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash e, *p;
2977
2978 if (! g->bfd2got)
2979 return g;
2980
2981 e.bfd = ibfd;
2982 p = htab_find (g->bfd2got, &e);
2983 return p ? p->g : NULL;
2984 }
2985
2986 /* Create one separate got for each bfd that has entries in the global
2987 got, such that we can tell how many local and global entries each
2988 bfd requires. */
2989
2990 static int
mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd(void ** entryp,void * p)2991 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd (void **entryp, void *p)
2992 {
2993 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
2994 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
2995 htab_t bfd2got = arg->bfd2got;
2996 struct mips_got_info *g;
2997 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash bfdgot_entry, *bfdgot;
2998 void **bfdgotp;
2999
3000 /* Find the got_info for this GOT entry's input bfd. Create one if
3001 none exists. */
3002 bfdgot_entry.bfd = entry->abfd;
3003 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (bfd2got, &bfdgot_entry, INSERT);
3004 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfdgotp;
3005
3006 if (bfdgot != NULL)
3007 g = bfdgot->g;
3008 else
3009 {
3010 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3011 (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3012
3013 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3014 {
3015 arg->obfd = 0;
3016 return 0;
3017 }
3018
3019 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3020
3021 bfdgot->bfd = entry->abfd;
3022 bfdgot->g = g = (struct mips_got_info *)
3023 bfd_alloc (arg->obfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3024 if (g == NULL)
3025 {
3026 arg->obfd = 0;
3027 return 0;
3028 }
3029
3030 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3031 g->global_gotno = 0;
3032 g->local_gotno = 0;
3033 g->assigned_gotno = -1;
3034 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3035 g->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3036 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3037 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3038 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3039 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3040 {
3041 arg->obfd = 0;
3042 return 0;
3043 }
3044
3045 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3046 g->next = NULL;
3047 }
3048
3049 /* Insert the GOT entry in the bfd's got entry hash table. */
3050 entryp = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3051 if (*entryp != NULL)
3052 return 1;
3053
3054 *entryp = entry;
3055
3056 if (entry->tls_type)
3057 {
3058 if (entry->tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3059 g->tls_gotno += 2;
3060 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3061 g->tls_gotno += 1;
3062 }
3063 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->forced_local)
3064 ++g->local_gotno;
3065 else
3066 ++g->global_gotno;
3067
3068 return 1;
3069 }
3070
3071 /* Attempt to merge gots of different input bfds. Try to use as much
3072 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
3073 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
3074 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
3075 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
3076 and then make make the new got current. */
3077
3078 static int
mips_elf_merge_gots(void ** bfd2got_,void * p)3079 mips_elf_merge_gots (void **bfd2got_, void *p)
3080 {
3081 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfd2got
3082 = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)*bfd2got_;
3083 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg = (struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *)p;
3084 unsigned int lcount = bfd2got->g->local_gotno;
3085 unsigned int gcount = bfd2got->g->global_gotno;
3086 unsigned int tcount = bfd2got->g->tls_gotno;
3087 unsigned int maxcnt = arg->max_count;
3088 bfd_boolean too_many_for_tls = FALSE;
3089
3090 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
3091 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
3092 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
3093 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
3094 if (tcount > 0)
3095 {
3096 unsigned int primary_total = lcount + tcount + arg->global_count;
3097 if (primary_total > maxcnt)
3098 too_many_for_tls = TRUE;
3099 }
3100
3101 /* If we don't have a primary GOT and this is not too big, use it as
3102 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
3103 if (! arg->primary && lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt
3104 && ! too_many_for_tls)
3105 {
3106 arg->primary = bfd2got->g;
3107 arg->primary_count = lcount + gcount;
3108 }
3109 /* If it looks like we can merge this bfd's entries with those of
3110 the primary, merge them. The heuristics is conservative, but we
3111 don't have to squeeze it too hard. */
3112 else if (arg->primary && ! too_many_for_tls
3113 && (arg->primary_count + lcount + gcount + tcount) <= maxcnt)
3114 {
3115 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3116 int old_lcount = arg->primary->local_gotno;
3117 int old_gcount = arg->primary->global_gotno;
3118 int old_tcount = arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3119
3120 bfd2got->g = arg->primary;
3121
3122 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3123 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3124 arg);
3125 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3126 return 0;
3127
3128 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3129 /* We don't have to worry about releasing memory of the actual
3130 got entries, since they're all in the master got_entries hash
3131 table anyway. */
3132
3133 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->primary->local_gotno);
3134 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->primary->global_gotno);
3135 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->primary->tls_gotno);
3136
3137 arg->primary_count = arg->primary->local_gotno
3138 + arg->primary->global_gotno + arg->primary->tls_gotno;
3139 }
3140 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
3141 else if (arg->current
3142 && arg->current_count + lcount + gcount + tcount <= maxcnt)
3143 {
3144 struct mips_got_info *g = bfd2got->g;
3145 int old_lcount = arg->current->local_gotno;
3146 int old_gcount = arg->current->global_gotno;
3147 int old_tcount = arg->current->tls_gotno;
3148
3149 bfd2got->g = arg->current;
3150
3151 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
3152 mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd,
3153 arg);
3154 if (arg->obfd == NULL)
3155 return 0;
3156
3157 htab_delete (g->got_entries);
3158
3159 BFD_ASSERT (old_lcount + lcount >= arg->current->local_gotno);
3160 BFD_ASSERT (old_gcount + gcount >= arg->current->global_gotno);
3161 BFD_ASSERT (old_tcount + tcount >= arg->current->tls_gotno);
3162
3163 arg->current_count = arg->current->local_gotno
3164 + arg->current->global_gotno + arg->current->tls_gotno;
3165 }
3166 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
3167 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
3168 overflows anyway. */
3169 else
3170 {
3171 bfd2got->g->next = arg->current;
3172 arg->current = bfd2got->g;
3173
3174 arg->current_count = lcount + gcount + 2 * tcount;
3175 }
3176
3177 return 1;
3178 }
3179
3180 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. ENTRYP's NEXT field
3181 is null iff there is just a single GOT. */
3182
3183 static int
mips_elf_initialize_tls_index(void ** entryp,void * p)3184 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *p)
3185 {
3186 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3187 struct mips_got_info *g = p;
3188 bfd_vma next_index;
3189 unsigned char tls_type;
3190
3191 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
3192 if (entry->tls_type == 0)
3193 return 1;
3194
3195 next_index = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (entry->abfd) * (long) g->tls_assigned_gotno;
3196
3197 if (entry->symndx == -1 && g->next == NULL)
3198 {
3199 /* A type (3) got entry in the single-GOT case. We use the symbol's
3200 hash table entry to track its index. */
3201 if (entry->d.h->tls_type & GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE)
3202 return 1;
3203 entry->d.h->tls_type |= GOT_TLS_OFFSET_DONE;
3204 entry->d.h->tls_got_offset = next_index;
3205 tls_type = entry->d.h->tls_type;
3206 }
3207 else
3208 {
3209 if (entry->tls_type & GOT_TLS_LDM)
3210 {
3211 /* There are separate mips_got_entry objects for each input bfd
3212 that requires an LDM entry. Make sure that all LDM entries in
3213 a GOT resolve to the same index. */
3214 if (g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_TWO && g->tls_ldm_offset != MINUS_ONE)
3215 {
3216 entry->gotidx = g->tls_ldm_offset;
3217 return 1;
3218 }
3219 g->tls_ldm_offset = next_index;
3220 }
3221 entry->gotidx = next_index;
3222 tls_type = entry->tls_type;
3223 }
3224
3225 /* Account for the entries we've just allocated. */
3226 if (tls_type & (GOT_TLS_GD | GOT_TLS_LDM))
3227 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 2;
3228 if (tls_type & GOT_TLS_IE)
3229 g->tls_assigned_gotno += 1;
3230
3231 return 1;
3232 }
3233
3234 /* If passed a NULL mips_got_info in the argument, set the marker used
3235 to tell whether a global symbol needs a got entry (in the primary
3236 got) to the given VALUE.
3237
3238 If passed a pointer G to a mips_got_info in the argument (it must
3239 not be the primary GOT), compute the offset from the beginning of
3240 the (primary) GOT section to the entry in G corresponding to the
3241 global symbol. G's assigned_gotno must contain the index of the
3242 first available global GOT entry in G. VALUE must contain the size
3243 of a GOT entry in bytes. For each global GOT entry that requires a
3244 dynamic relocation, NEEDED_RELOCS is incremented, and the symbol is
3245 marked as not eligible for lazy resolution through a function
3246 stub. */
3247 static int
mips_elf_set_global_got_offset(void ** entryp,void * p)3248 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset (void **entryp, void *p)
3249 {
3250 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3251 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *arg
3252 = (struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg *)p;
3253 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
3254
3255 if (g && entry->tls_type != GOT_NORMAL)
3256 arg->needed_relocs +=
3257 mips_tls_got_relocs (arg->info, entry->tls_type,
3258 entry->symndx == -1 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3259
3260 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1
3261 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1
3262 && entry->d.h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL)
3263 {
3264 if (g)
3265 {
3266 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotsym == NULL);
3267
3268 entry->gotidx = arg->value * (long) g->assigned_gotno++;
3269 if (arg->info->shared
3270 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
3271 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
3272 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
3273 ++arg->needed_relocs;
3274 }
3275 else
3276 entry->d.h->root.got.offset = arg->value;
3277 }
3278
3279 return 1;
3280 }
3281
3282 /* Mark any global symbols referenced in the GOT we are iterating over
3283 as inelligible for lazy resolution stubs. */
3284 static int
mips_elf_set_no_stub(void ** entryp,void * p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3285 mips_elf_set_no_stub (void **entryp, void *p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3286 {
3287 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3288
3289 if (entry->abfd != NULL
3290 && entry->symndx == -1
3291 && entry->d.h->root.dynindx != -1)
3292 entry->d.h->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
3293
3294 return 1;
3295 }
3296
3297 /* Follow indirect and warning hash entries so that each got entry
3298 points to the final symbol definition. P must point to a pointer
3299 to the hash table we're traversing. Since this traversal may
3300 modify the hash table, we set this pointer to NULL to indicate
3301 we've made a potentially-destructive change to the hash table, so
3302 the traversal must be restarted. */
3303 static int
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry(void ** entryp,void * p)3304 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry (void **entryp, void *p)
3305 {
3306 struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)*entryp;
3307 htab_t got_entries = *(htab_t *)p;
3308
3309 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
3310 {
3311 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = entry->d.h;
3312
3313 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3314 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3315 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3316
3317 if (entry->d.h == h)
3318 return 1;
3319
3320 entry->d.h = h;
3321
3322 /* If we can't find this entry with the new bfd hash, re-insert
3323 it, and get the traversal restarted. */
3324 if (! htab_find (got_entries, entry))
3325 {
3326 htab_clear_slot (got_entries, entryp);
3327 entryp = htab_find_slot (got_entries, entry, INSERT);
3328 if (! *entryp)
3329 *entryp = entry;
3330 /* Abort the traversal, since the whole table may have
3331 moved, and leave it up to the parent to restart the
3332 process. */
3333 *(htab_t *)p = NULL;
3334 return 0;
3335 }
3336 /* We might want to decrement the global_gotno count, but it's
3337 either too early or too late for that at this point. */
3338 }
3339
3340 return 1;
3341 }
3342
3343 /* Turn indirect got entries in a got_entries table into their final
3344 locations. */
3345 static void
mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries(struct mips_got_info * g)3346 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct mips_got_info *g)
3347 {
3348 htab_t got_entries;
3349
3350 do
3351 {
3352 got_entries = g->got_entries;
3353
3354 htab_traverse (got_entries,
3355 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entry,
3356 &got_entries);
3357 }
3358 while (got_entries == NULL);
3359 }
3360
3361 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
3362 the primary GOT. */
3363 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_adjust_gp(bfd * abfd,struct mips_got_info * g,bfd * ibfd)3364 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
3365 {
3366 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3367 return 0;
3368
3369 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (g, ibfd);
3370 if (! g)
3371 return 0;
3372
3373 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
3374
3375 g = g->next;
3376
3377 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
3378 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3379 }
3380
3381 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
3382 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
3383
3384 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_multi_got(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct mips_got_info * g,asection * got,bfd_size_type pages)3385 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3386 struct mips_got_info *g, asection *got,
3387 bfd_size_type pages)
3388 {
3389 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
3390 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
3391 struct mips_got_info *gg;
3392 unsigned int assign;
3393
3394 g->bfd2got = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_hash,
3395 mips_elf_bfd2got_entry_eq, NULL);
3396 if (g->bfd2got == NULL)
3397 return FALSE;
3398
3399 got_per_bfd_arg.bfd2got = g->bfd2got;
3400 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
3401 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
3402
3403 /* Count how many GOT entries each input bfd requires, creating a
3404 map from bfd to got info while at that. */
3405 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_make_got_per_bfd, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3406 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3407 return FALSE;
3408
3409 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
3410 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
3411 /* Taking out PAGES entries is a worst-case estimate. We could
3412 compute the maximum number of pages that each separate input bfd
3413 uses, but it's probably not worth it. */
3414 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
3415 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
3416 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info) - pages);
3417 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
3418 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_offset below for more
3419 information. */
3420 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
3421
3422 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
3423 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
3424 to be the primary GOT. */
3425 htab_traverse (g->bfd2got, mips_elf_merge_gots, &got_per_bfd_arg);
3426 if (got_per_bfd_arg.obfd == NULL)
3427 return FALSE;
3428
3429 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
3430 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
3431 {
3432 g->next = (struct mips_got_info *)
3433 bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3434 if (g->next == NULL)
3435 return FALSE;
3436
3437 g->next->global_gotsym = NULL;
3438 g->next->global_gotno = 0;
3439 g->next->local_gotno = 0;
3440 g->next->tls_gotno = 0;
3441 g->next->assigned_gotno = 0;
3442 g->next->tls_assigned_gotno = 0;
3443 g->next->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3444 g->next->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_multi_got_entry_hash,
3445 mips_elf_multi_got_entry_eq,
3446 NULL);
3447 if (g->next->got_entries == NULL)
3448 return FALSE;
3449 g->next->bfd2got = NULL;
3450 }
3451 else
3452 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
3453 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
3454
3455 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
3456 gg = g;
3457 g = g->next;
3458
3459 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
3460 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
3461 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
3462 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
3463 list. */
3464 {
3465 struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *bfdgot;
3466 void **bfdgotp;
3467
3468 bfdgot = (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash *)bfd_alloc
3469 (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_bfd2got_hash));
3470
3471 if (bfdgot == NULL)
3472 return FALSE;
3473
3474 bfdgot->bfd = abfd;
3475 bfdgot->g = g;
3476 bfdgotp = htab_find_slot (gg->bfd2got, bfdgot, INSERT);
3477
3478 BFD_ASSERT (*bfdgotp == NULL);
3479 *bfdgotp = bfdgot;
3480 }
3481
3482 /* The IRIX dynamic linker requires every symbol that is referenced
3483 in a dynamic relocation to be present in the primary GOT, so
3484 arrange for them to appear after those that are actually
3485 referenced.
3486
3487 GNU/Linux could very well do without it, but it would slow down
3488 the dynamic linker, since it would have to resolve every dynamic
3489 symbol referenced in other GOTs more than once, without help from
3490 the cache. Also, knowing that every external symbol has a GOT
3491 helps speed up the resolution of local symbols too, so GNU/Linux
3492 follows IRIX's practice.
3493
3494 The number 2 is used by mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f to count
3495 global GOT symbols that are unreferenced in the primary GOT, with
3496 an initial dynamic index computed from gg->assigned_gotno, where
3497 the number of unreferenced global entries in the primary GOT is
3498 preserved. */
3499 if (1)
3500 {
3501 gg->assigned_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
3502 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
3503 set_got_offset_arg.value = 2;
3504 }
3505 else
3506 {
3507 /* This could be used for dynamic linkers that don't optimize
3508 symbol resolution while applying relocations so as to use
3509 primary GOT entries or assuming the symbol is locally-defined.
3510 With this code, we assign lower dynamic indices to global
3511 symbols that are not referenced in the primary GOT, so that
3512 their entries can be omitted. */
3513 gg->assigned_gotno = 0;
3514 set_got_offset_arg.value = -1;
3515 }
3516
3517 /* Reorder dynamic symbols as described above (which behavior
3518 depends on the setting of VALUE). */
3519 set_got_offset_arg.g = NULL;
3520 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3521 &set_got_offset_arg);
3522 set_got_offset_arg.value = 1;
3523 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
3524 &set_got_offset_arg);
3525 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
3526 return FALSE;
3527
3528 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
3529 [assigned_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
3530 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
3531 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
3532 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
3533 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
3534 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
3535 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
3536 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
3537 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
3538 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
3539 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
3540 points back to the master GOT. */
3541 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
3542 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
3543 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
3544 assign = 0;
3545 gg->next = gg;
3546
3547 do
3548 {
3549 struct mips_got_info *gn;
3550
3551 assign += MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3552 g->assigned_gotno = assign;
3553 g->local_gotno += assign + pages;
3554 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
3555
3556 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
3557 list that gg points to. g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
3558 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
3559 gn = g->next;
3560 g->next = gg->next;
3561 gg->next = g;
3562
3563 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
3564 all non-TLS entries. */
3565 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
3566 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
3567
3568 /* Move onto the next GOT. It will be a secondary GOT if nonull. */
3569 g = gn;
3570
3571 /* Mark global symbols in every non-primary GOT as ineligible for
3572 stubs. */
3573 if (g)
3574 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_no_stub, NULL);
3575 }
3576 while (g);
3577
3578 got->size = (gg->next->local_gotno
3579 + gg->next->global_gotno
3580 + gg->next->tls_gotno) * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3581
3582 return TRUE;
3583 }
3584
3585
3586 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
3587 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
3588
3589 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
mips_elf_next_relocation(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int r_type,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relend)3590 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
3591 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3592 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
3593 {
3594 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
3595
3596 while (relocation < relend)
3597 {
3598 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
3599 && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
3600 return relocation;
3601
3602 ++relocation;
3603 }
3604
3605 /* We didn't find it. */
3606 return NULL;
3607 }
3608
3609 /* Return whether a relocation is against a local symbol. */
3610
3611 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_local_relocation_p(bfd * input_bfd,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,asection ** local_sections,bfd_boolean check_forced)3612 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
3613 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3614 asection **local_sections,
3615 bfd_boolean check_forced)
3616 {
3617 unsigned long r_symndx;
3618 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3619 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3620 size_t extsymoff;
3621
3622 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3623 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3624 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3625
3626 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
3627 return TRUE;
3628 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
3629 return TRUE;
3630
3631 if (check_forced)
3632 {
3633 /* Look up the hash table to check whether the symbol
3634 was forced local. */
3635 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3636 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
3637 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3638 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3639 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3640 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3641 if (h->root.forced_local)
3642 return TRUE;
3643 }
3644
3645 return FALSE;
3646 }
3647
3648 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
3649
3650 bfd_vma
_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend(bfd_vma value,int bits)3651 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3652 {
3653 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
3654 /* VALUE is negative. */
3655 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
3656
3657 return value;
3658 }
3659
3660 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
3661 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
3662 BITS. */
3663
3664 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_overflow_p(bfd_vma value,int bits)3665 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
3666 {
3667 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
3668
3669 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
3670 /* The value is too big. */
3671 return TRUE;
3672 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
3673 /* The value is too small. */
3674 return TRUE;
3675
3676 /* All is well. */
3677 return FALSE;
3678 }
3679
3680 /* Calculate the %high function. */
3681
3682 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_high(bfd_vma value)3683 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
3684 {
3685 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
3686 }
3687
3688 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
3689
3690 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_higher(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3691 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3692 {
3693 #ifdef BFD64
3694 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
3695 #else
3696 abort ();
3697 return MINUS_ONE;
3698 #endif
3699 }
3700
3701 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
3702
3703 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_highest(bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3704 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3705 {
3706 #ifdef BFD64
3707 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
3708 #else
3709 abort ();
3710 return MINUS_ONE;
3711 #endif
3712 }
3713
3714 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
3715
3716 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3717 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
3718 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3719 {
3720 flagword flags;
3721 register asection *s;
3722
3723 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
3724 {
3725 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3726 | SEC_READONLY);
3727
3728 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
3729 if (s == NULL
3730 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
3731 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
3732 return FALSE;
3733
3734 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
3735 }
3736
3737 return TRUE;
3738 }
3739
3740 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
3741
3742 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_got_section(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)3743 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3744 bfd_boolean maybe_exclude)
3745 {
3746 flagword flags;
3747 register asection *s;
3748 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3749 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
3750 struct mips_got_info *g;
3751 bfd_size_type amt;
3752 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3753
3754 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3755
3756 /* This function may be called more than once. */
3757 s = mips_elf_got_section (abfd, TRUE);
3758 if (s)
3759 {
3760 if (! maybe_exclude)
3761 s->flags &= ~SEC_EXCLUDE;
3762 return TRUE;
3763 }
3764
3765 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3766 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3767
3768 if (maybe_exclude)
3769 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
3770
3771 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
3772 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
3773 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
3774 if (s == NULL
3775 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3776 return FALSE;
3777
3778 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
3779 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
3780 are not creating a global offset table. */
3781 bh = NULL;
3782 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
3783 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
3784 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
3785 return FALSE;
3786
3787 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
3788 h->non_elf = 0;
3789 h->def_regular = 1;
3790 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
3791 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
3792
3793 if (info->shared
3794 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
3795 return FALSE;
3796
3797 amt = sizeof (struct mips_got_info);
3798 g = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
3799 if (g == NULL)
3800 return FALSE;
3801 g->global_gotsym = NULL;
3802 g->global_gotno = 0;
3803 g->tls_gotno = 0;
3804 g->local_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3805 g->assigned_gotno = MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
3806 g->bfd2got = NULL;
3807 g->next = NULL;
3808 g->tls_ldm_offset = MINUS_ONE;
3809 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3810 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3811 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3812 return FALSE;
3813 mips_elf_section_data (s)->u.got_info = g;
3814 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
3815 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
3816
3817 /* VxWorks also needs a .got.plt section. */
3818 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3819 {
3820 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
3821 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3822 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
3823 if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
3824 return FALSE;
3825
3826 htab->sgotplt = s;
3827 }
3828 return TRUE;
3829 }
3830
3831 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
3832 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols. These symbols are only special for
3833 shared objects; they are not used in executables. */
3834
3835 static bfd_boolean
is_gott_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)3836 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3837 {
3838 return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
3839 && info->shared
3840 && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
3841 || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
3842 }
3843
3844 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
3845 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
3846 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
3847
3848 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
3849 REQUIRE_JALXP indicates whether or not the opcode used with this
3850 relocation must be JALX.
3851
3852 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
3853 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
3854 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
3855 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
3856
3857 static bfd_reloc_status_type
mips_elf_calculate_relocation(bfd * abfd,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma addend,reloc_howto_type * howto,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,bfd_vma * valuep,const char ** namep,bfd_boolean * require_jalxp,bfd_boolean save_addend)3858 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
3859 asection *input_section,
3860 struct bfd_link_info *info,
3861 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
3862 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
3863 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
3864 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
3865 const char **namep, bfd_boolean *require_jalxp,
3866 bfd_boolean save_addend)
3867 {
3868 /* The eventual value we will return. */
3869 bfd_vma value;
3870 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
3871 occurring. */
3872 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
3873 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
3874 shared object file being produced. */
3875 bfd_vma gp = MINUS_ONE;
3876 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
3877 relocated. */
3878 bfd_vma p;
3879 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
3880 bfd_vma gp0 = MINUS_ONE;
3881 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
3882 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
3883 during execution. */
3884 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
3885 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
3886 located. */
3887 asection *sec = NULL;
3888 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
3889 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
3890 symbol. */
3891 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
3892 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
3893 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
3894 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
3895 "__gnu_local_gp". */
3896 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
3897 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3898 size_t extsymoff;
3899 unsigned long r_symndx;
3900 int r_type;
3901 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
3902 relocation value. */
3903 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
3904 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
3905 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
3906 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3907 bfd *dynobj;
3908
3909 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3910 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3911
3912 /* Parse the relocation. */
3913 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3914 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
3915 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
3916 + input_section->output_offset
3917 + relocation->r_offset);
3918
3919 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
3920 overflowed_p = FALSE;
3921
3922 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
3923 used in the array of hash table entries. */
3924 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
3925 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
3926 local_sections, FALSE);
3927 was_local_p = local_p;
3928 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
3929 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3930 else
3931 {
3932 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
3933 must come before globals. */
3934 extsymoff = 0;
3935 }
3936
3937 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
3938 if (local_p)
3939 {
3940 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
3941
3942 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
3943 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
3944
3945 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3946 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) != STT_SECTION
3947 || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
3948 symbol += sym->st_value;
3949 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
3950 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
3951 {
3952 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
3953 addend -= symbol;
3954 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
3955 }
3956
3957 /* MIPS16 text labels should be treated as odd. */
3958 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
3959 ++symbol;
3960
3961 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3962 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
3963 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
3964 sym->st_name);
3965 if (*namep == '\0')
3966 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
3967
3968 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16);
3969 }
3970 else
3971 {
3972 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
3973
3974 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
3975 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
3976 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
3977 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
3978 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3979 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3980 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
3981
3982 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
3983 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
3984
3985 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
3986 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
3987 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
3988 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
3989 {
3990 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
3991 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
3992 if (r_type != R_MIPS_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS_LO16
3993 && r_type != R_MIPS16_HI16 && r_type != R_MIPS16_LO16)
3994 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
3995
3996 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
3997 }
3998 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
3999 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
4000 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
4001 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
4002
4003
4004 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
4005 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
4006 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
4007 its defined. */
4008 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4009 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4010 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
4011 {
4012 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4013 if (sec->output_section)
4014 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
4015 + sec->output_section->vma
4016 + sec->output_offset);
4017 else
4018 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
4019 }
4020 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4021 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
4022 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
4023 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
4024 addresses. */
4025 symbol = 0;
4026 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
4027 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
4028 symbol = 0;
4029 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
4030 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
4031 {
4032 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
4033 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
4034 in in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
4035 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
4036 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
4037 somehow as well. */
4038 BFD_ASSERT (! info->shared);
4039 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
4040 symbol = 0;
4041 }
4042 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
4043 {
4044 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
4045 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
4046 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
4047 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
4048 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
4049 which is available from here:
4050 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
4051 symbol = 0;
4052 }
4053 else
4054 {
4055 if (! ((*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
4056 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
4057 input_section, relocation->r_offset,
4058 (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR)
4059 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other))))
4060 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4061 symbol = 0;
4062 }
4063
4064 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (h->root.other == STO_MIPS16);
4065 }
4066
4067 /* If this is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function with a stub, we
4068 need to redirect the call to the stub, unless we're already *in*
4069 a stub. */
4070 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4071 && ((h != NULL && h->fn_stub != NULL)
4072 || (local_p
4073 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
4074 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4075 && !mips16_stub_section_p (input_bfd, input_section))
4076 {
4077 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
4078 have already noticed that we were going to need the
4079 stub. */
4080 if (local_p)
4081 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
4082 else
4083 {
4084 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
4085 sec = h->fn_stub;
4086 }
4087
4088 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4089 /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't. */
4090 target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
4091 }
4092 /* If this is a 16-bit call to a 32- or 64-bit function with a stub, we
4093 need to redirect the call to the stub. */
4094 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !info->relocatable
4095 && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
4096 || (local_p
4097 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
4098 && elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
4099 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4100 {
4101 if (local_p)
4102 sec = elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
4103 else
4104 {
4105 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
4106 out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
4107 file. */
4108 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
4109 {
4110 asection *o;
4111
4112 sec = NULL;
4113 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
4114 {
4115 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
4116 {
4117 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4118 break;
4119 }
4120 }
4121 if (sec == NULL)
4122 sec = h->call_stub;
4123 }
4124 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
4125 sec = h->call_stub;
4126 else
4127 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
4128 }
4129
4130 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
4131 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
4132 }
4133
4134 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
4135 special jalx instruction. */
4136 *require_jalxp = (!info->relocatable
4137 && (((r_type == R_MIPS16_26) && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
4138 || ((r_type == R_MIPS_26) && target_is_16_bit_code_p)));
4139
4140 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4141 local_sections, TRUE);
4142
4143 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, or the GP value,
4144 and we're going to need it, get it now. */
4145 switch (r_type)
4146 {
4147 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4148 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4149 /* We need to decay to GOT_DISP/addend if the symbol doesn't
4150 bind locally. */
4151 local_p = local_p || _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p (&h->root, info, 1);
4152 if (local_p || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_OFST)
4153 break;
4154 /* Fall through. */
4155
4156 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4157 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4158 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4159 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4160 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4161 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4162 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4163 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4164 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4165 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4166 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
4167 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
4168 {
4169 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4170 0, 0, NULL, r_type);
4171 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4172 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4173 }
4174 else if (!local_p)
4175 {
4176 /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
4177 entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub. */
4178 if (htab->is_vxworks
4179 && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16
4180 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
4181 || r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16))
4182 {
4183 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
4184 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
4185 g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
4186 }
4187 else
4188 {
4189 /* GOT_PAGE may take a non-zero addend, that is ignored in a
4190 GOT_PAGE relocation that decays to GOT_DISP because the
4191 symbol turns out to be global. The addend is then added
4192 as GOT_OFST. */
4193 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
4194 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, input_bfd,
4195 &h->root, r_type, info);
4196 if (h->tls_type == GOT_NORMAL
4197 && (! elf_hash_table(info)->dynamic_sections_created
4198 || (info->shared
4199 && (info->symbolic || h->root.forced_local)
4200 && h->root.def_regular)))
4201 {
4202 /* This is a static link or a -Bsymbolic link. The
4203 symbol is defined locally, or was forced to be local.
4204 We must initialize this entry in the GOT. */
4205 asection *sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
4206 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, sgot->contents + g);
4207 }
4208 }
4209 }
4210 else if (!htab->is_vxworks
4211 && (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)))
4212 /* The calculation below does not involve "g". */
4213 break;
4214 else
4215 {
4216 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4217 symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
4218 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
4219 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4220 }
4221
4222 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
4223 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, g);
4224 break;
4225
4226 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4227 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4228 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4229 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4230 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4231 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4232 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4233 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4234 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
4235 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
4236 if (dynobj)
4237 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL),
4238 input_bfd);
4239 break;
4240
4241 default:
4242 break;
4243 }
4244
4245 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
4246 symbol = gp;
4247
4248 /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
4249 symbols are resolved by the loader. Add them to .rela.dyn. */
4250 if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
4251 {
4252 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
4253 bfd_byte *loc;
4254 asection *s;
4255
4256 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4257 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4258
4259 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
4260 + input_section->output_offset
4261 + relocation->r_offset);
4262 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
4263 outrel.r_addend = addend;
4264 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
4265
4266 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4267 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4268 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
4269 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4270 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4271
4272 *valuep = 0;
4273 return bfd_reloc_ok;
4274 }
4275
4276 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
4277 switch (r_type)
4278 {
4279 case R_MIPS_NONE:
4280 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4281
4282 case R_MIPS_16:
4283 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4284 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4285 break;
4286
4287 case R_MIPS_32:
4288 case R_MIPS_REL32:
4289 case R_MIPS_64:
4290 if ((info->shared
4291 || (!htab->is_vxworks
4292 && htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
4293 && h != NULL
4294 && h->root.def_dynamic
4295 && !h->root.def_regular))
4296 && r_symndx != 0
4297 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4298 {
4299 /* If we're creating a shared library, or this relocation is
4300 against a symbol in a shared library, then we can't know
4301 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
4302 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
4303 linker.
4304
4305 In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
4306 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
4307 no need to add a dynamic relocation here. */
4308 value = addend;
4309 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
4310 info,
4311 relocation,
4312 h,
4313 sec,
4314 symbol,
4315 &value,
4316 input_section))
4317 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
4318 }
4319 else
4320 {
4321 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4322 value = symbol + addend;
4323 else
4324 value = addend;
4325 }
4326 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4327 break;
4328
4329 case R_MIPS_PC32:
4330 value = symbol + addend - p;
4331 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4332 break;
4333
4334 case R_MIPS16_26:
4335 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
4336 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
4337 the output file that's different. That's handled in
4338 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
4339 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
4340 case R_MIPS_26:
4341 if (local_p)
4342 value = ((addend | ((p + 4) & 0xf0000000)) + symbol) >> 2;
4343 else
4344 {
4345 value = (_bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28) + symbol) >> 2;
4346 if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
4347 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> 28);
4348 }
4349 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4350 break;
4351
4352 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
4353 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
4354 & howto->dst_mask);
4355 break;
4356
4357 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
4358 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
4359 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
4360 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4361 break;
4362
4363 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
4364 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
4365 & howto->dst_mask);
4366 break;
4367
4368 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
4369 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
4370 break;
4371
4372 case R_MIPS_HI16:
4373 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
4374 if (!gp_disp_p)
4375 {
4376 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
4377 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4378 }
4379 else
4380 {
4381 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4382 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4383 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4384 8: sll $v0,16
4385 12: addu $v0,$v1
4386 14: move $gp,$v0
4387 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4388 $pc is four higher than $t9 would be, so reduce
4389 both reloc addends by 4. */
4390 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
4391 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 4);
4392 else
4393 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
4394 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4395 }
4396 break;
4397
4398 case R_MIPS_LO16:
4399 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
4400 if (!gp_disp_p)
4401 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
4402 else
4403 {
4404 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4405 for this conditional. */
4406 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
4407 value = addend + gp - p;
4408 else
4409 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
4410 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4411 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
4412 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
4413 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
4414 this:
4415
4416 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4417 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4418 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
4419
4420 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4421 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
4422 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4423 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4424 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4425 not check for overflow here. */
4426 }
4427 break;
4428
4429 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
4430 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
4431 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
4432 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
4433 here. */
4434
4435 /* Fall through. */
4436
4437 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
4438 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
4439 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
4440 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
4441 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
4442 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
4443 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
4444 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
4445 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
4446 if (howto->partial_inplace)
4447 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
4448 value = symbol + addend - gp;
4449 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
4450 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
4451 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
4452 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
4453 to them before. */
4454 if (was_local_p)
4455 value += gp0;
4456 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4457 break;
4458
4459 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
4460 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
4461 /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
4462 R_MIPS_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G". */
4463 if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
4464 {
4465 bfd_boolean forced;
4466
4467 forced = ! mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
4468 local_sections, FALSE);
4469 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
4470 symbol + addend, forced);
4471 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4472 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4473 value
4474 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4475 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4476 break;
4477 }
4478
4479 /* Fall through. */
4480
4481 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
4482 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
4483 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
4484 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
4485 got_disp:
4486 value = g;
4487 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4488 break;
4489
4490 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
4491 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
4492 if (!save_addend)
4493 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4494 break;
4495
4496 case R_MIPS_PC16:
4497 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
4498 value = symbol + _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18) - p;
4499 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
4500 value >>= howto->rightshift;
4501 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4502 break;
4503
4504 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
4505 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
4506 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
4507 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
4508 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
4509 value = g;
4510 value = mips_elf_high (value);
4511 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4512 break;
4513
4514 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
4515 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
4516 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
4517 break;
4518
4519 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
4520 /* GOT_PAGE relocations that reference non-local symbols decay
4521 to GOT_DISP. The corresponding GOT_OFST relocation decays to
4522 0. */
4523 if (! local_p)
4524 goto got_disp;
4525 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
4526 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
4527 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
4528 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (dynobj, abfd, input_bfd, value);
4529 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4530 break;
4531
4532 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
4533 if (local_p)
4534 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
4535 else
4536 value = addend;
4537 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
4538 break;
4539
4540 case R_MIPS_SUB:
4541 value = symbol - addend;
4542 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4543 break;
4544
4545 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
4546 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
4547 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4548 break;
4549
4550 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
4551 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
4552 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4553 break;
4554
4555 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
4556 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
4557 value &= howto->dst_mask;
4558 break;
4559
4560 case R_MIPS_JALR:
4561 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
4562 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
4563 branches to the PLT; that will wind up wasting time. */
4564 if (h != NULL && h->root.plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
4565 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4566 value = symbol + addend;
4567 break;
4568
4569 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
4570 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4571 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
4572 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
4573 return bfd_reloc_continue;
4574
4575 default:
4576 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
4577 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
4578 }
4579
4580 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
4581 *valuep = value;
4582 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
4583 }
4584
4585 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
4586
4587 static bfd_vma
mips_elf_obtain_contents(reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd * input_bfd,bfd_byte * contents)4588 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
4589 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4590 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
4591 {
4592 bfd_vma x;
4593 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4594
4595 /* Obtain the bytes. */
4596 x = bfd_get ((8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto)), input_bfd, location);
4597
4598 return x;
4599 }
4600
4601 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
4602 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
4603 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
4604 relocation applies. If REQUIRE_JALX is TRUE, then the opcode used
4605 for the relocation must be either JAL or JALX, and it is
4606 unconditionally converted to JALX.
4607
4608 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
4609
4610 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_perform_relocation(struct bfd_link_info * info,reloc_howto_type * howto,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocation,bfd_vma value,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,bfd_boolean require_jalx)4611 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4612 reloc_howto_type *howto,
4613 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
4614 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
4615 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
4616 bfd_boolean require_jalx)
4617 {
4618 bfd_vma x;
4619 bfd_byte *location;
4620 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
4621
4622 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
4623 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
4624
4625 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
4626
4627 /* Obtain the current value. */
4628 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
4629
4630 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
4631 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
4632
4633 /* Set the field. */
4634 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
4635
4636 /* If required, turn JAL into JALX. */
4637 if (require_jalx)
4638 {
4639 bfd_boolean ok;
4640 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
4641 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
4642
4643 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
4644 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
4645 {
4646 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
4647 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4648 }
4649 else
4650 {
4651 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
4652 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4653 }
4654
4655 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. */
4656 if (!ok)
4657 {
4658 (*_bfd_error_handler)
4659 (_("%B: %A+0x%lx: jump to stub routine which is not jal"),
4660 input_bfd,
4661 input_section,
4662 (unsigned long) relocation->r_offset);
4663 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4664 return FALSE;
4665 }
4666
4667 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
4668 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4669 }
4670
4671 /* On the RM9000, bal is faster than jal, because bal uses branch
4672 prediction hardware. If we are linking for the RM9000, and we
4673 see jal, and bal fits, use it instead. Note that this
4674 transformation should be safe for all architectures. */
4675 if (bfd_get_mach (input_bfd) == bfd_mach_mips9000
4676 && !info->relocatable
4677 && !require_jalx
4678 && ((r_type == R_MIPS_26 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
4679 || (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR && x == 0x0320f809))) /* jalr t9 */
4680 {
4681 bfd_vma addr;
4682 bfd_vma dest;
4683 bfd_signed_vma off;
4684
4685 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
4686 + input_section->output_offset
4687 + relocation->r_offset
4688 + 4);
4689 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
4690 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
4691 else
4692 dest = value;
4693 off = dest - addr;
4694 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
4695 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
4696 }
4697
4698 /* Put the value into the output. */
4699 bfd_put (8 * bfd_get_reloc_size (howto), input_bfd, x, location);
4700
4701 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, !info->relocatable,
4702 location);
4703
4704 return TRUE;
4705 }
4706
4707 /* Returns TRUE if SECTION is a MIPS16 stub section. */
4708
4709 static bfd_boolean
mips16_stub_section_p(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * section)4710 mips16_stub_section_p (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section)
4711 {
4712 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, section);
4713
4714 return FN_STUB_P (name) || CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name);
4715 }
4716
4717 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD. */
4718
4719 static void
mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,unsigned int n)4720 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4721 unsigned int n)
4722 {
4723 asection *s;
4724 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4725
4726 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4727 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4728 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4729
4730 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4731 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
4732 else
4733 {
4734 if (s->size == 0)
4735 {
4736 /* Make room for a null element. */
4737 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4738 ++s->reloc_count;
4739 }
4740 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4741 }
4742 }
4743
4744 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
4745 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
4746 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
4747 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
4748
4749 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,const Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry * h,asection * sec,bfd_vma symbol,bfd_vma * addendp,asection * input_section)4750 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
4751 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4752 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4753 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4754 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
4755 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
4756 {
4757 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
4758 asection *sreloc;
4759 bfd *dynobj;
4760 int r_type;
4761 long indx;
4762 bfd_boolean defined_p;
4763 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4764
4765 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4766 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
4767 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4768 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4769 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
4770 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
4771 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
4772 < sreloc->size);
4773
4774 outrel[0].r_offset =
4775 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
4776 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4777 {
4778 outrel[1].r_offset =
4779 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
4780 outrel[2].r_offset =
4781 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
4782 }
4783
4784 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
4785 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
4786 return TRUE;
4787
4788 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
4789 {
4790 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
4791 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
4792 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
4793 *addendp += symbol;
4794 return TRUE;
4795 }
4796
4797 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
4798 in the relocation. */
4799 if (h != NULL
4800 && (sec == NULL || !h->root.def_regular
4801 || (info->shared && !info->symbolic && !h->root.forced_local)))
4802 {
4803 indx = h->root.dynindx;
4804 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4805 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
4806 else
4807 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
4808 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
4809 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
4810 undefined symbols. */
4811 defined_p = FALSE;
4812 }
4813 else
4814 {
4815 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
4816 indx = 0;
4817 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
4818 {
4819 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4820 return FALSE;
4821 }
4822 else
4823 {
4824 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
4825 if (indx == 0)
4826 {
4827 asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
4828 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
4829 }
4830 if (indx == 0)
4831 abort ();
4832 }
4833
4834 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
4835 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
4836 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
4837 local symbols because we used to generate them
4838 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
4839 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
4840 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
4841 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
4842 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
4843 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
4844 as well. */
4845 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
4846 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
4847 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
4848 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
4849 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
4850 indx = 0;
4851 defined_p = TRUE;
4852 }
4853
4854 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
4855 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
4856 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
4857 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
4858 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
4859 *addendp += symbol;
4860
4861 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4862 /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this. */
4863 outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
4864 else
4865 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
4866 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
4867 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
4868 R_MIPS_REL32);
4869
4870 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
4871 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
4872 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
4873 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
4874 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
4875 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
4876 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
4877 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
4878 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
4879 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
4880 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
4881 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
4882 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
4883 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
4884 ? R_MIPS_64
4885 : R_MIPS_NONE);
4886 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
4887
4888 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
4889 correct location in the output file. */
4890 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4891 + input_section->output_offset);
4892 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4893 + input_section->output_offset);
4894 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
4895 + input_section->output_offset);
4896
4897 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
4898 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
4899 relocation format is non-standard. */
4900 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
4901 {
4902 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
4903 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4904 (sreloc->contents
4905 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
4906 }
4907 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
4908 {
4909 /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations. */
4910 outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
4911 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
4912 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4913 (sreloc->contents
4914 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
4915 }
4916 else
4917 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
4918 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
4919 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
4920
4921 /* We've now added another relocation. */
4922 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
4923
4924 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
4925 will be writing to it. */
4926 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
4927 |= SHF_WRITE;
4928
4929 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
4930 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
4931 {
4932 asection *scpt = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
4933 bfd_byte *cr;
4934
4935 if (scpt)
4936 {
4937 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
4938
4939 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
4940 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
4941 + input_section->output_section->vma
4942 + input_section->output_offset);
4943 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
4944 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
4945 else
4946 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
4947 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
4948 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
4949
4950 cr = (scpt->contents
4951 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
4952 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
4953 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
4954 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
4955 + scpt->reloc_count));
4956 ++scpt->reloc_count;
4957 }
4958 }
4959
4960 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
4961 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
4962 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
4963 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
4964 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
4965
4966 return TRUE;
4967 }
4968
4969 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
4970
4971 unsigned long
_bfd_elf_mips_mach(flagword flags)4972 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
4973 {
4974 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
4975 {
4976 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
4977 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
4978
4979 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
4980 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
4981
4982 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
4983 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
4984
4985 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
4986 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
4987
4988 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
4989 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
4990
4991 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
4992 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
4993
4994 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
4995 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
4996
4997 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
4998 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
4999
5000 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
5001 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
5002
5003 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
5004 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
5005
5006 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
5007 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
5008
5009 default:
5010 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
5011 {
5012 default:
5013 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
5014 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
5015
5016 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
5017 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
5018
5019 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
5020 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
5021
5022 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
5023 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
5024
5025 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
5026 return bfd_mach_mips5;
5027
5028 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
5029 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
5030
5031 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
5032 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
5033
5034 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
5035 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
5036
5037 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
5038 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
5039 }
5040 }
5041
5042 return 0;
5043 }
5044
5045 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
5046
5047 static INLINE char *
elf_mips_abi_name(bfd * abfd)5048 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
5049 {
5050 flagword flags;
5051
5052 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
5053 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
5054 {
5055 case 0:
5056 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
5057 return "N32";
5058 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
5059 return "64";
5060 else
5061 return "none";
5062 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
5063 return "O32";
5064 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
5065 return "O64";
5066 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
5067 return "EABI32";
5068 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
5069 return "EABI64";
5070 default:
5071 return "unknown abi";
5072 }
5073 }
5074
5075 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
5076 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
5077 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
5078 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
5079 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
5080 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
5081 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5082 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5083
5084 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
5085 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
5086 definition in a shared library. */
5087 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
5088 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5089 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5090
5091 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use.
5092 This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5093
5094 void
_bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing(bfd * abfd,asymbol * asym)5095 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
5096 {
5097 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
5098
5099 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
5100 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
5101 {
5102 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5103 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
5104 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
5105 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
5106 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
5107 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
5108 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
5109 {
5110 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
5111 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
5112 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
5113 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5114 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5115 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
5116 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
5117 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5118 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5119 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
5120 }
5121 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
5122 break;
5123
5124 case SHN_COMMON:
5125 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5126 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
5127 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5128 || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
5129 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5130 break;
5131 /* Fall through. */
5132 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5133 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
5134 {
5135 /* Initialize the small common section. */
5136 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
5137 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
5138 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5139 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5140 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
5141 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
5142 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
5143 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5144 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
5145 }
5146 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
5147 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
5148 break;
5149
5150 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5151 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5152 break;
5153
5154 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5155 {
5156 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
5157
5158 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5159 if (section != NULL)
5160 {
5161 asym->section = section;
5162 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5163 to the base of the .text section. So substract the section
5164 base address to make it an offset. */
5165 asym->value -= section->vma;
5166 }
5167 }
5168 break;
5169
5170 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5171 {
5172 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
5173
5174 BFD_ASSERT (SGI_COMPAT (abfd));
5175 if (section != NULL)
5176 {
5177 asym->section = section;
5178 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
5179 to the base of the .data section. So substract the section
5180 base address to make it an offset. */
5181 asym->value -= section->vma;
5182 }
5183 }
5184 break;
5185 }
5186 }
5187
5188 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
5189 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
5190
5191 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
5192 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
5193 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
5194 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
5195 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
5196
5197 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
5198 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
5199 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
5200 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
5201
5202 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
5203 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
5204 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
5205 We therefore take the following approach:
5206
5207 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
5208 determine the pointer size.
5209
5210 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
5211 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
5212
5213 - Otherwise punt.
5214
5215 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
5216 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
5217 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
5218 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
5219 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
5220
5221 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
5222 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
5223 did so. */
5224
5225 unsigned int
_bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size(bfd * abfd,asection * sec)5226 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
5227 {
5228 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
5229 return 8;
5230 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
5231 {
5232 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
5233
5234 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
5235 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
5236 if (long32_p && long64_p)
5237 return 0;
5238 if (long32_p)
5239 return 4;
5240 if (long64_p)
5241 return 8;
5242
5243 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
5244 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
5245 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
5246 == R_MIPS_64))
5247 return 8;
5248
5249 return 0;
5250 }
5251 return 4;
5252 }
5253
5254 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
5255 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
5256 same address. For example, if we have code like:
5257
5258 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
5259 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
5260 jalr $25
5261
5262 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
5263 will jump there rather than to .text.
5264
5265 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
5266 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
5267
5268 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols(bfd * abfd)5269 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
5270 {
5271 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
5272 }
5273
5274 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
5275 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
5276 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
5277 a better way. */
5278
5279 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_processing(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr)5280 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
5281 {
5282 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
5283 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
5284 {
5285 bfd_byte buf[4];
5286
5287 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
5288 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
5289
5290 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5291 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
5292 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5293 return FALSE;
5294 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5295 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5296 return FALSE;
5297 }
5298
5299 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
5300 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5301 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
5302 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
5303 {
5304 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5305
5306 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
5307 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
5308 so that we don't have to read them again.
5309 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
5310 through the section contents to see if there is an
5311 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
5312
5313 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
5314 l = contents;
5315 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5316 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5317 {
5318 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5319
5320 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5321 &intopt);
5322 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5323 {
5324 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5325 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5326 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5327 break;
5328 }
5329 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5330 {
5331 bfd_byte buf[8];
5332
5333 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5334 (hdr->sh_offset
5335 + (l - contents)
5336 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5337 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
5338 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5339 return FALSE;
5340 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5341 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
5342 return FALSE;
5343 }
5344 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5345 {
5346 bfd_byte buf[4];
5347
5348 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
5349 (hdr->sh_offset
5350 + (l - contents)
5351 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
5352 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
5353 SEEK_SET) != 0)
5354 return FALSE;
5355 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
5356 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
5357 return FALSE;
5358 }
5359 l += intopt.size;
5360 }
5361 }
5362
5363 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
5364 {
5365 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
5366
5367 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5368 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
5369 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
5370 {
5371 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5372 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5373 }
5374 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
5375 {
5376 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5377 hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
5378 }
5379 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
5380 {
5381 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5382 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5383 }
5384 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
5385 {
5386 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
5387 hdr->sh_type = SHT_PROGBITS;
5388 }
5389 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
5390 {
5391 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
5392 {
5393 unsigned int adjust;
5394
5395 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
5396 if (adjust != 0)
5397 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
5398 }
5399 }
5400 }
5401
5402 return TRUE;
5403 }
5404
5405 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
5406 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
5407 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
5408
5409 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
5410 how to. */
5411
5412 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,const char * name,int shindex)5413 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
5414 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
5415 const char *name,
5416 int shindex)
5417 {
5418 flagword flags = 0;
5419
5420 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
5421 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
5422 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
5423 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
5424 probably get away with this. */
5425 switch (hdr->sh_type)
5426 {
5427 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
5428 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
5429 return FALSE;
5430 break;
5431 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
5432 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
5433 return FALSE;
5434 break;
5435 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
5436 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
5437 return FALSE;
5438 break;
5439 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
5440 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5441 return FALSE;
5442 break;
5443 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
5444 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
5445 return FALSE;
5446 break;
5447 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
5448 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
5449 return FALSE;
5450 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
5451 break;
5452 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
5453 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
5454 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
5455 return FALSE;
5456 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
5457 break;
5458 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
5459 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
5460 return FALSE;
5461 break;
5462 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
5463 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5464 return FALSE;
5465 break;
5466 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
5467 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5468 return FALSE;
5469 break;
5470 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
5471 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5472 return FALSE;
5473 break;
5474 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
5475 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
5476 return FALSE;
5477 break;
5478 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
5479 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5480 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5481 return FALSE;
5482 break;
5483 default:
5484 break;
5485 }
5486
5487 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
5488 return FALSE;
5489
5490 if (flags)
5491 {
5492 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5493 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
5494 hdr->bfd_section)
5495 | flags)))
5496 return FALSE;
5497 }
5498
5499 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
5500
5501 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
5502 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
5503 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
5504 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
5505 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
5506 {
5507 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
5508 Elf32_RegInfo s;
5509
5510 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
5511 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
5512 return FALSE;
5513 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
5514 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
5515 }
5516
5517 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
5518 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
5519 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
5520 they should agree. */
5521 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
5522 {
5523 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
5524
5525 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
5526 if (contents == NULL)
5527 return FALSE;
5528 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
5529 0, hdr->sh_size))
5530 {
5531 free (contents);
5532 return FALSE;
5533 }
5534 l = contents;
5535 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
5536 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
5537 {
5538 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
5539
5540 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
5541 &intopt);
5542 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
5543 {
5544 (*_bfd_error_handler)
5545 (_("%B: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than its header"),
5546 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
5547 break;
5548 }
5549 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5550 {
5551 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
5552
5553 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
5554 (abfd,
5555 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
5556 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5557 &intreg);
5558 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5559 }
5560 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
5561 {
5562 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
5563
5564 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
5565 (abfd,
5566 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
5567 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
5568 &intreg);
5569 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
5570 }
5571 l += intopt.size;
5572 }
5573 free (contents);
5574 }
5575
5576 return TRUE;
5577 }
5578
5579 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
5580 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
5581 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
5582
5583 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections(bfd * abfd,Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr,asection * sec)5584 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
5585 {
5586 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
5587
5588 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
5589 {
5590 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
5591 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
5592 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5593 }
5594 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
5595 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
5596 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
5597 {
5598 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
5599 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
5600 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5601 }
5602 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
5603 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
5604 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
5605 {
5606 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
5607 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
5608 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5609 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5610 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5611 else
5612 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5613 }
5614 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
5615 {
5616 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
5617 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
5618 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
5619 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5620 {
5621 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
5622 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5623 else
5624 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5625 }
5626 else
5627 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
5628 }
5629 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5630 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
5631 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
5632 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
5633 {
5634 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5635 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
5636 #if 0
5637 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
5638 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
5639 #endif
5640 }
5641 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
5642 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
5643 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
5644 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
5645 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
5646 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
5647 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5648 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
5649 {
5650 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
5651 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5652 }
5653 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
5654 {
5655 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
5656 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5657 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
5658 }
5659 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
5660 {
5661 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
5662 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
5663 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5664 }
5665 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_"))
5666 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
5667 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
5668 {
5669 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
5670 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
5671 final_write_processing. */
5672 }
5673 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
5674 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
5675 {
5676 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
5677 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
5678 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
5679 }
5680 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
5681 {
5682 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
5683 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
5684 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
5685 }
5686
5687 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
5688 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
5689 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
5690 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
5691 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
5692
5693 return TRUE;
5694 }
5695
5696 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
5697 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
5698 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
5699 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
5700 the .scommon section. */
5701
5702 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,int * retval)5703 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5704 asection *sec, int *retval)
5705 {
5706 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
5707 {
5708 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5709 return TRUE;
5710 }
5711 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
5712 {
5713 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
5714 return TRUE;
5715 }
5716 return FALSE;
5717 }
5718
5719 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
5720 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
5721
5722 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,const char ** namep,flagword * flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection ** secp,bfd_vma * valp)5723 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
5724 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
5725 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5726 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
5727 {
5728 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5729 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
5730 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
5731 {
5732 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
5733 *namep = NULL;
5734 return TRUE;
5735 }
5736
5737 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
5738 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
5739 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
5740 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
5741 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
5742 is not done for them. */
5743 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
5744 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
5745 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
5746 {
5747 *namep = NULL;
5748 return TRUE;
5749 }
5750
5751 switch (sym->st_shndx)
5752 {
5753 case SHN_COMMON:
5754 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
5755 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
5756 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
5757 || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
5758 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
5759 break;
5760 /* Fall through. */
5761 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
5762 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
5763 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
5764 *valp = sym->st_size;
5765 break;
5766
5767 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
5768 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5769 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
5770 {
5771 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
5772 asection *elf_text_section;
5773 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5774
5775 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5776 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
5777 return FALSE;
5778
5779 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5780 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5781 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
5782 return FALSE;
5783
5784 /* Initialize the section. */
5785
5786 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
5787 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5788
5789 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
5790 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
5791
5792 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
5793 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5794 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
5795 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
5796 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
5797 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5798 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
5799 }
5800 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5801 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5802 so I took it out. */
5803 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
5804 break;
5805
5806 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
5807 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
5808 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
5809 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
5810 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
5811 {
5812 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
5813 asection *elf_data_section;
5814 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
5815
5816 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5817 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
5818 return FALSE;
5819
5820 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
5821 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5822 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
5823 return FALSE;
5824
5825 /* Initialize the section. */
5826
5827 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
5828 elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5829
5830 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
5831 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
5832
5833 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
5834 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
5835 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
5836 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
5837 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
5838 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
5839 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
5840 }
5841 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
5842 info->shared. I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
5843 so I took it out. */
5844 *secp = elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
5845 break;
5846
5847 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
5848 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
5849 break;
5850 }
5851
5852 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
5853 && ! info->shared
5854 && info->hash->creator == abfd->xvec
5855 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
5856 {
5857 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5858 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5859
5860 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
5861 bh = NULL;
5862 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5863 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
5864 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5865 return FALSE;
5866
5867 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5868 h->non_elf = 0;
5869 h->def_regular = 1;
5870 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5871
5872 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5873 return FALSE;
5874
5875 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
5876 }
5877
5878 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
5879 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
5880 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
5881 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5882 ++*valp;
5883
5884 return TRUE;
5885 }
5886
5887 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
5888 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
5889 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
5890
5891 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook(struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym,asection * input_sec,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)5892 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
5893 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5894 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
5895 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5896 {
5897 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
5898 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
5899 common in the output file. */
5900 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
5901 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
5902 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
5903
5904 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
5905 sym->st_value &= ~1;
5906
5907 return TRUE;
5908 }
5909
5910 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
5911
5912 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
5913
5914 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)5915 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5916 {
5917 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5918 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5919 flagword flags;
5920 register asection *s;
5921 const char * const *namep;
5922 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5923
5924 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5925 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5926 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
5927
5928 /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
5929 EABI doesn't. */
5930 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
5931 {
5932 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
5933 if (s != NULL)
5934 {
5935 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
5936 return FALSE;
5937 }
5938 }
5939
5940 /* We need to create .got section. */
5941 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info, FALSE))
5942 return FALSE;
5943
5944 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
5945 return FALSE;
5946
5947 /* Create .stub section. */
5948 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5949 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd)) == NULL)
5950 {
5951 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
5952 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
5953 flags | SEC_CODE);
5954 if (s == NULL
5955 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5956 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5957 return FALSE;
5958 }
5959
5960 if ((IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
5961 && !info->shared
5962 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
5963 {
5964 s = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
5965 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
5966 if (s == NULL
5967 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5968 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5969 return FALSE;
5970 }
5971
5972 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
5973 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
5974 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
5975 the linker takes such action. */
5976 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
5977 {
5978 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
5979 {
5980 bh = NULL;
5981 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5982 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
5983 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5984 return FALSE;
5985
5986 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5987 h->non_elf = 0;
5988 h->def_regular = 1;
5989 h->type = STT_SECTION;
5990
5991 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5992 return FALSE;
5993 }
5994
5995 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
5996 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
5997 {
5998 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
5999 return FALSE;
6000 }
6001
6002 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
6003 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".hash");
6004 if (s != NULL)
6005 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6006 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
6007 if (s != NULL)
6008 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6009 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
6010 if (s != NULL)
6011 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6012 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
6013 if (s != NULL)
6014 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6015 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
6016 if (s != NULL)
6017 bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
6018 }
6019
6020 if (!info->shared)
6021 {
6022 const char *name;
6023
6024 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
6025 bh = NULL;
6026 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6027 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
6028 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6029 return FALSE;
6030
6031 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6032 h->non_elf = 0;
6033 h->def_regular = 1;
6034 h->type = STT_SECTION;
6035
6036 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6037 return FALSE;
6038
6039 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
6040 {
6041 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
6042 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
6043 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
6044 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
6045 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rld_map");
6046 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6047
6048 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
6049 bh = NULL;
6050 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
6051 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
6052 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
6053 return FALSE;
6054
6055 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
6056 h->non_elf = 0;
6057 h->def_regular = 1;
6058 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
6059
6060 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
6061 return FALSE;
6062 }
6063 }
6064
6065 if (htab->is_vxworks)
6066 {
6067 /* Create the .plt, .rela.plt, .dynbss and .rela.bss sections.
6068 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE symbol. */
6069 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
6070 return FALSE;
6071
6072 /* Cache the sections created above. */
6073 htab->sdynbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynbss");
6074 htab->srelbss = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.bss");
6075 htab->srelplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
6076 htab->splt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
6077 if (!htab->sdynbss
6078 || (!htab->srelbss && !info->shared)
6079 || !htab->srelplt
6080 || !htab->splt)
6081 abort ();
6082
6083 /* Do the usual VxWorks handling. */
6084 if (!elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
6085 return FALSE;
6086
6087 /* Work out the PLT sizes. */
6088 if (info->shared)
6089 {
6090 htab->plt_header_size
6091 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
6092 htab->plt_entry_size
6093 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
6094 }
6095 else
6096 {
6097 htab->plt_header_size
6098 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
6099 htab->plt_entry_size
6100 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
6101 }
6102 }
6103
6104 return TRUE;
6105 }
6106
6107 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
6108 allocate space in the global offset table. */
6109
6110 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,asection * sec,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs)6111 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
6112 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
6113 {
6114 const char *name;
6115 bfd *dynobj;
6116 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6117 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6118 struct mips_got_info *g;
6119 size_t extsymoff;
6120 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6121 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
6122 asection *sgot;
6123 asection *sreloc;
6124 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6125 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6126
6127 if (info->relocatable)
6128 return TRUE;
6129
6130 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6131 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6132 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6133 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
6134 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6135
6136 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
6137
6138 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
6139 if (FN_STUB_P (name))
6140 {
6141 unsigned long r_symndx;
6142
6143 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6144 this is for. */
6145
6146 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6147
6148 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6149 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6150 {
6151 asection *o;
6152
6153 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
6154 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
6155 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
6156 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6157 {
6158 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6159 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6160
6161 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
6162 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6163 || o->reloc_count == 0
6164 || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6165 continue;
6166
6167 sec_relocs
6168 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6169 info->keep_memory);
6170 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6171 return FALSE;
6172
6173 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6174 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6175 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6176 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) != R_MIPS16_26)
6177 break;
6178
6179 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6180 free (sec_relocs);
6181
6182 if (r < rend)
6183 break;
6184 }
6185
6186 if (o == NULL)
6187 {
6188 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6189 not need it. Since this function is called before
6190 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6191 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6192 flag. */
6193 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6194 return TRUE;
6195 }
6196
6197 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
6198 this BFD. */
6199 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
6200 {
6201 unsigned long symcount;
6202 asection **n;
6203 bfd_size_type amt;
6204
6205 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6206 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6207 else
6208 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6209 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6210 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6211 if (n == NULL)
6212 return FALSE;
6213 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
6214 }
6215
6216 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6217 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6218
6219 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6220 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6221 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
6222 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
6223 }
6224 else
6225 {
6226 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6227
6228 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6229 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6230
6231 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6232 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6233 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6234
6235 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
6236
6237 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6238 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
6239 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6240 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6241 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
6242 if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
6243 {
6244 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6245 return TRUE;
6246 }
6247
6248 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6249 h->fn_stub = sec;
6250 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6251 }
6252 }
6253 else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6254 {
6255 unsigned long r_symndx;
6256 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6257 asection **loc;
6258
6259 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
6260 this is for. */
6261
6262 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocs->r_info);
6263
6264 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
6265 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
6266 {
6267 asection *o;
6268
6269 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
6270 needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
6271 that refers to this symbol. */
6272 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
6273 {
6274 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
6275 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
6276
6277 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
6278 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
6279 || o->reloc_count == 0
6280 || mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, o))
6281 continue;
6282
6283 sec_relocs
6284 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
6285 info->keep_memory);
6286 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
6287 return FALSE;
6288
6289 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
6290 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
6291 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
6292 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
6293 break;
6294
6295 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
6296 free (sec_relocs);
6297
6298 if (r < rend)
6299 break;
6300 }
6301
6302 if (o == NULL)
6303 {
6304 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
6305 not need it. Since this function is called before
6306 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
6307 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
6308 flag. */
6309 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6310 return TRUE;
6311 }
6312
6313 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
6314 this BFD. */
6315 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
6316 {
6317 unsigned long symcount;
6318 asection **n;
6319 bfd_size_type amt;
6320
6321 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
6322 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
6323 else
6324 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6325 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
6326 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
6327 if (n == NULL)
6328 return FALSE;
6329 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
6330 }
6331
6332 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6333 elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
6334
6335 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
6336 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
6337 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
6338 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
6339 }
6340 else
6341 {
6342 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6343 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6344
6345 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
6346
6347 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
6348 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
6349 else
6350 loc = &h->call_stub;
6351
6352 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
6353 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
6354 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
6355 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
6356 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
6357 if (*loc != NULL)
6358 {
6359 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
6360 return TRUE;
6361 }
6362
6363 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
6364 *loc = sec;
6365 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
6366 }
6367 }
6368
6369 if (dynobj == NULL)
6370 {
6371 sgot = NULL;
6372 g = NULL;
6373 }
6374 else
6375 {
6376 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
6377 if (sgot == NULL)
6378 g = NULL;
6379 else
6380 {
6381 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
6382 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
6383 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
6384 }
6385 }
6386
6387 sreloc = NULL;
6388 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6389 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6390 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
6391 {
6392 unsigned long r_symndx;
6393 unsigned int r_type;
6394 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6395
6396 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
6397 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
6398
6399 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
6400 h = NULL;
6401 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
6402 {
6403 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6404 (_("%B: Malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
6405 abfd, name);
6406 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6407 return FALSE;
6408 }
6409 else
6410 {
6411 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
6412
6413 /* This may be an indirect symbol created because of a version. */
6414 if (h != NULL)
6415 {
6416 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
6417 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
6418 }
6419 }
6420
6421 /* Some relocs require a global offset table. */
6422 if (dynobj == NULL || sgot == NULL)
6423 {
6424 switch (r_type)
6425 {
6426 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6427 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6428 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6429 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6430 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6431 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6432 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6433 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6434 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6435 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6436 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6437 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6438 if (dynobj == NULL)
6439 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6440 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, FALSE))
6441 return FALSE;
6442 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6443 if (htab->is_vxworks && !info->shared)
6444 {
6445 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6446 (_("%B: GOT reloc at 0x%lx not expected in executables"),
6447 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6448 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6449 return FALSE;
6450 }
6451 break;
6452
6453 case R_MIPS_32:
6454 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6455 case R_MIPS_64:
6456 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6457 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6458 no need to add a dynamic relocation here. */
6459 if (dynobj == NULL
6460 && (info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6461 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6462 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6463 break;
6464
6465 default:
6466 break;
6467 }
6468 }
6469
6470 if (h)
6471 {
6472 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_relocation_target = TRUE;
6473
6474 /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
6475 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader. Allocate
6476 room for them in .rela.dyn. */
6477 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
6478 {
6479 if (sreloc == NULL)
6480 {
6481 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6482 if (sreloc == NULL)
6483 return FALSE;
6484 }
6485 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6486 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6487 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6488 relocations against the text segment. */
6489 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6490 }
6491 }
6492 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
6493 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
6494 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP
6495 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16 && htab->is_vxworks))
6496 {
6497 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
6498 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
6499 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
6500 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS_GOT16 and
6501 R_MIPS_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
6502 always evaluate to "G". We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
6503 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
6504 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
6505 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6506 rel->r_addend, g, 0))
6507 return FALSE;
6508 }
6509
6510 switch (r_type)
6511 {
6512 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6513 if (h == NULL)
6514 {
6515 (*_bfd_error_handler)
6516 (_("%B: CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol"),
6517 abfd, (unsigned long) rel->r_offset);
6518 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6519 return FALSE;
6520 }
6521 /* Fall through. */
6522
6523 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6524 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6525 if (h != NULL)
6526 {
6527 /* VxWorks call relocations point the function's .got.plt
6528 entry, which will be allocated by adjust_dynamic_symbol.
6529 Otherwise, this symbol requires a global GOT entry. */
6530 if (!htab->is_vxworks
6531 && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6532 return FALSE;
6533
6534 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
6535 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
6536 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
6537 h->needs_plt = 1;
6538 h->type = STT_FUNC;
6539 }
6540 break;
6541
6542 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6543 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
6544 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
6545 if (h == NULL)
6546 break;
6547 else
6548 {
6549 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6550 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6551
6552 while (hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6553 || hmips->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6554 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6555 hmips->root.root.u.i.link;
6556
6557 if (hmips->root.def_regular
6558 && ! (info->shared && ! info->symbolic
6559 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
6560 break;
6561 }
6562 /* Fall through. */
6563
6564 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6565 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6566 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6567 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6568 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6569 return FALSE;
6570 break;
6571
6572 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6573 if (info->shared)
6574 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
6575 /* Fall through */
6576
6577 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6578 if (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM)
6579 {
6580 r_symndx = 0;
6581 h = NULL;
6582 }
6583 /* Fall through */
6584
6585 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6586 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
6587 for TLS GD relocations. */
6588 {
6589 unsigned char flag = (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
6590 ? GOT_TLS_GD
6591 : r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
6592 ? GOT_TLS_LDM
6593 : GOT_TLS_IE);
6594 if (h != NULL)
6595 {
6596 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
6597 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6598 hmips->tls_type |= flag;
6599
6600 if (h && ! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, flag))
6601 return FALSE;
6602 }
6603 else
6604 {
6605 BFD_ASSERT (flag == GOT_TLS_LDM || r_symndx != 0);
6606
6607 if (! mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
6608 rel->r_addend, g, flag))
6609 return FALSE;
6610 }
6611 }
6612 break;
6613
6614 case R_MIPS_32:
6615 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6616 case R_MIPS_64:
6617 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
6618 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
6619 no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation. */
6620 if ((info->shared || (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks))
6621 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6622 {
6623 if (sreloc == NULL)
6624 {
6625 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
6626 if (sreloc == NULL)
6627 return FALSE;
6628 }
6629 if (info->shared)
6630 {
6631 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
6632 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
6633 relocs. Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn. */
6634 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
6635 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6636 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
6637 relocations against the text segment. */
6638 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6639 }
6640 else
6641 {
6642 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6643
6644 /* We only need to copy this reloc if the symbol is
6645 defined in a dynamic object. */
6646 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6647 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
6648 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
6649 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
6650 are relocations against the text segment. */
6651 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
6652 }
6653
6654 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for
6655 this symbol, a symbol must have a dynamic symbol
6656 table index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are
6657 dynamic relocations against it. This does not apply
6658 to VxWorks, which does not have the usual coupling
6659 between global GOT entries and .dynsym entries. */
6660 if (h != NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
6661 {
6662 if (dynobj == NULL)
6663 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
6664 if (! mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info, TRUE))
6665 return FALSE;
6666 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &sgot);
6667 if (! mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, g, 0))
6668 return FALSE;
6669 }
6670 }
6671
6672 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6673 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6674 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6675 break;
6676
6677 case R_MIPS_PC16:
6678 if (h)
6679 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6680 break;
6681
6682 case R_MIPS_26:
6683 if (h)
6684 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->is_branch_target = TRUE;
6685 /* Fall through. */
6686
6687 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
6688 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
6689 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6690 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
6691 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
6692 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
6693 break;
6694
6695 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
6696 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
6697 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6698 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6699 return FALSE;
6700 break;
6701
6702 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
6703 used. Record for later use during GC. */
6704 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6705 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
6706 return FALSE;
6707 break;
6708
6709 default:
6710 break;
6711 }
6712
6713 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
6714 related to taking the function's address. This doesn't apply to
6715 VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer to a .got.plt entry instead of
6716 a normal .got entry. */
6717 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h != NULL)
6718 switch (r_type)
6719 {
6720 default:
6721 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
6722 break;
6723 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6724 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6725 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6726 case R_MIPS_JALR:
6727 break;
6728 }
6729
6730 /* If this reloc is not a 16 bit call, and it has a global
6731 symbol, then we will need the fn_stub if there is one.
6732 References from a stub section do not count. */
6733 if (h != NULL
6734 && r_type != R_MIPS16_26
6735 && !mips16_stub_section_p (abfd, sec))
6736 {
6737 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
6738
6739 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6740 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
6741 }
6742 }
6743
6744 return TRUE;
6745 }
6746
6747 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_relax_section(bfd * abfd,asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,bfd_boolean * again)6748 _bfd_mips_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
6749 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6750 bfd_boolean *again)
6751 {
6752 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
6753 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
6754 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6755 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6756 size_t extsymoff;
6757 bfd_boolean changed_contents = FALSE;
6758 bfd_vma sec_start = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
6759 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6760
6761 /* We are not currently changing any sizes, so only one pass. */
6762 *again = FALSE;
6763
6764 if (link_info->relocatable)
6765 return TRUE;
6766
6767 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
6768 link_info->keep_memory);
6769 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6770 return TRUE;
6771
6772 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count
6773 * get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
6774 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
6775 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6776
6777 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6778 {
6779 bfd_vma symval;
6780 bfd_signed_vma sym_offset;
6781 unsigned int r_type;
6782 unsigned long r_symndx;
6783 asection *sym_sec;
6784 unsigned long instruction;
6785
6786 /* Turn jalr into bgezal, and jr into beq, if they're marked
6787 with a JALR relocation, that indicate where they jump to.
6788 This saves some pipeline bubbles. */
6789 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, irel->r_info);
6790 if (r_type != R_MIPS_JALR)
6791 continue;
6792
6793 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, irel->r_info);
6794 /* Compute the address of the jump target. */
6795 if (r_symndx >= extsymoff)
6796 {
6797 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h
6798 = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
6799 elf_sym_hashes (abfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
6800
6801 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6802 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6803 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
6804
6805 /* If a symbol is undefined, or if it may be overridden,
6806 skip it. */
6807 if (! ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6808 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6809 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
6810 || (link_info->shared && ! link_info->symbolic
6811 && !h->root.forced_local))
6812 continue;
6813
6814 sym_sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
6815 if (sym_sec->output_section)
6816 symval = (h->root.root.u.def.value
6817 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6818 + sym_sec->output_offset);
6819 else
6820 symval = h->root.root.u.def.value;
6821 }
6822 else
6823 {
6824 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6825
6826 /* Read this BFD's symbols if we haven't done so already. */
6827 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
6828 {
6829 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
6830 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6831 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
6832 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
6833 NULL, NULL, NULL);
6834 if (isymbuf == NULL)
6835 goto relax_return;
6836 }
6837
6838 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
6839 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
6840 continue;
6841 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6842 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6843 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
6844 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
6845 else
6846 sym_sec
6847 = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
6848 symval = isym->st_value
6849 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
6850 + sym_sec->output_offset;
6851 }
6852
6853 /* Compute branch offset, from delay slot of the jump to the
6854 branch target. */
6855 sym_offset = (symval + irel->r_addend)
6856 - (sec_start + irel->r_offset + 4);
6857
6858 /* Branch offset must be properly aligned. */
6859 if ((sym_offset & 3) != 0)
6860 continue;
6861
6862 sym_offset >>= 2;
6863
6864 /* Check that it's in range. */
6865 if (sym_offset < -0x8000 || sym_offset >= 0x8000)
6866 continue;
6867
6868 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
6869 if (contents == NULL)
6870 {
6871 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6872 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6873 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
6874 else
6875 {
6876 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
6877 goto relax_return;
6878 }
6879 }
6880
6881 instruction = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + irel->r_offset);
6882
6883 /* If it was jalr <reg>, turn it into bgezal $zero, <target>. */
6884 if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x0000f809)
6885 instruction = 0x04110000;
6886 /* If it was jr <reg>, turn it into b <target>. */
6887 else if ((instruction & 0xfc1fffff) == 0x00000008)
6888 instruction = 0x10000000;
6889 else
6890 continue;
6891
6892 instruction |= (sym_offset & 0xffff);
6893 bfd_put_32 (abfd, instruction, contents + irel->r_offset);
6894 changed_contents = TRUE;
6895 }
6896
6897 if (contents != NULL
6898 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6899 {
6900 if (!changed_contents && !link_info->keep_memory)
6901 free (contents);
6902 else
6903 {
6904 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6905 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6906 }
6907 }
6908 return TRUE;
6909
6910 relax_return:
6911 if (contents != NULL
6912 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6913 free (contents);
6914 return FALSE;
6915 }
6916
6917 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
6918 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
6919 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
6920 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
6921 understand. */
6922
6923 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)6924 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6925 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6926 {
6927 bfd *dynobj;
6928 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
6929 asection *s;
6930 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6931
6932 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6933 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6934
6935 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
6936 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
6937 && (h->needs_plt
6938 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
6939 || (h->def_dynamic
6940 && h->ref_regular
6941 && !h->def_regular)));
6942
6943 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, we need to copy
6944 any R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output
6945 file. */
6946 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6947 if (! info->relocatable
6948 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
6949 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
6950 || !h->def_regular))
6951 {
6952 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
6953 (dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
6954 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
6955 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
6956 against the text segment. */
6957 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6958 }
6959
6960 /* For a function, create a stub, if allowed. */
6961 if (! hmips->no_fn_stub
6962 && h->needs_plt)
6963 {
6964 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
6965 return TRUE;
6966
6967 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
6968 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
6969 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
6970 executable and the shared library. */
6971 if (!h->def_regular)
6972 {
6973 /* We need .stub section. */
6974 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
6975 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
6976 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
6977
6978 h->root.u.def.section = s;
6979 h->root.u.def.value = s->size;
6980
6981 /* XXX Write this stub address somewhere. */
6982 h->plt.offset = s->size;
6983
6984 /* Make room for this stub code. */
6985 s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
6986
6987 /* The last half word of the stub will be filled with the index
6988 of this symbol in .dynsym section. */
6989 return TRUE;
6990 }
6991 }
6992 else if ((h->type == STT_FUNC)
6993 && !h->needs_plt)
6994 {
6995 /* This will set the entry for this symbol in the GOT to 0, and
6996 the dynamic linker will take care of this. */
6997 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
6998 return TRUE;
6999 }
7000
7001 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7002 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7003 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
7004 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7005 {
7006 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7007 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7008 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7009 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7010 return TRUE;
7011 }
7012
7013 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7014 is not a function. */
7015
7016 return TRUE;
7017 }
7018
7019 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
7020
7021 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)7022 _bfd_mips_vxworks_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
7023 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
7024 {
7025 bfd *dynobj;
7026 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
7027 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7028
7029 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7030 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7031 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
7032
7033 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
7034 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
7035 && (h->needs_plt
7036 || h->needs_copy
7037 || h->u.weakdef != NULL
7038 || (h->def_dynamic
7039 && h->ref_regular
7040 && !h->def_regular)));
7041
7042 /* If the symbol is defined by a dynamic object, we need a PLT stub if
7043 either (a) we want to branch to the symbol or (b) we're linking an
7044 executable that needs a canonical function address. In the latter
7045 case, the canonical address will be the address of the executable's
7046 load stub. */
7047 if ((hmips->is_branch_target
7048 || (!info->shared
7049 && h->type == STT_FUNC
7050 && hmips->is_relocation_target))
7051 && h->def_dynamic
7052 && h->ref_regular
7053 && !h->def_regular
7054 && !h->forced_local)
7055 h->needs_plt = 1;
7056
7057 /* Locally-binding symbols do not need a PLT stub; we can refer to
7058 the functions directly. */
7059 else if (h->needs_plt
7060 && (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
7061 || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
7062 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)))
7063 {
7064 h->needs_plt = 0;
7065 return TRUE;
7066 }
7067
7068 if (h->needs_plt)
7069 {
7070 /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, allocate room
7071 for the header, and for the header's .rela.plt.unloaded entries. */
7072 if (htab->splt->size == 0)
7073 {
7074 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_header_size;
7075 if (!info->shared)
7076 htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7077 }
7078
7079 /* Assign the next .plt entry to this symbol. */
7080 h->plt.offset = htab->splt->size;
7081 htab->splt->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
7082
7083 /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
7084 symbol's value to the address of the stub. For executables,
7085 point at the PLT load stub rather than the lazy resolution stub;
7086 this stub will become the canonical function address. */
7087 if (!h->def_regular)
7088 {
7089 h->root.u.def.section = htab->splt;
7090 h->root.u.def.value = h->plt.offset;
7091 if (!info->shared)
7092 h->root.u.def.value += 8;
7093 }
7094
7095 /* Make room for the .got.plt entry and the R_JUMP_SLOT relocation. */
7096 htab->sgotplt->size += 4;
7097 htab->srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7098
7099 /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations. */
7100 if (!info->shared)
7101 htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7102
7103 return TRUE;
7104 }
7105
7106 /* If a function symbol is defined by a dynamic object, and we do not
7107 need a PLT stub for it, the symbol's value should be zero. */
7108 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
7109 && h->def_dynamic
7110 && h->ref_regular
7111 && !h->def_regular)
7112 {
7113 h->root.u.def.value = 0;
7114 return TRUE;
7115 }
7116
7117 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
7118 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
7119 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
7120 if (h->u.weakdef != NULL)
7121 {
7122 BFD_ASSERT (h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7123 || h->u.weakdef->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
7124 h->root.u.def.section = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.section;
7125 h->root.u.def.value = h->u.weakdef->root.u.def.value;
7126 return TRUE;
7127 }
7128
7129 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
7130 is not a function. */
7131 if (info->shared)
7132 return TRUE;
7133
7134 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
7135 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
7136 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
7137 object will contain position independent code, so all references
7138 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
7139 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
7140 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
7141 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
7142 same memory location for the variable. */
7143
7144 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7145 {
7146 htab->srelbss->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
7147 h->needs_copy = 1;
7148 }
7149
7150 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (h, htab->sdynbss);
7151 }
7152
7153 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
7154 The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
7155 much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
7156 the current linking stage. */
7157
7158 static bfd_size_type
count_section_dynsyms(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7159 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7160 {
7161 bfd_size_type count;
7162
7163 count = 0;
7164 if (info->shared || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
7165 {
7166 asection *p;
7167 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7168
7169 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7170 for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
7171 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
7172 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
7173 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
7174 ++count;
7175 }
7176 return count;
7177 }
7178
7179 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
7180 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
7181 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
7182
7183 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7184 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7185 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7186 {
7187 asection *ri;
7188
7189 bfd *dynobj;
7190 asection *s;
7191 struct mips_got_info *g;
7192 int i;
7193 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
7194 bfd_size_type local_gotno;
7195 bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
7196 bfd *sub;
7197 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg count_tls_arg;
7198 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7199
7200 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7201
7202 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
7203 ri = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
7204 if (ri != NULL)
7205 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, ri, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
7206
7207 if (! (info->relocatable
7208 || ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen))
7209 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
7210 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs, NULL);
7211
7212 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7213 if (dynobj == NULL)
7214 /* Relocatable links don't have it. */
7215 return TRUE;
7216
7217 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, &s);
7218 if (s == NULL)
7219 return TRUE;
7220
7221 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
7222 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
7223 required. */
7224 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub; sub = sub->link_next)
7225 {
7226 asection *subsection;
7227
7228 for (subsection = sub->sections;
7229 subsection;
7230 subsection = subsection->next)
7231 {
7232 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
7233 continue;
7234 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
7235 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
7236 }
7237 }
7238
7239 /* There has to be a global GOT entry for every symbol with
7240 a dynamic symbol table index of DT_MIPS_GOTSYM or
7241 higher. Therefore, it make sense to put those symbols
7242 that need GOT entries at the end of the symbol table. We
7243 do that here. */
7244 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, 1))
7245 return FALSE;
7246
7247 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
7248 i = elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount - g->global_gotsym->dynindx;
7249 else
7250 /* If there are no global symbols, or none requiring
7251 relocations, then GLOBAL_GOTSYM will be NULL. */
7252 i = 0;
7253
7254 /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
7255 At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
7256 and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
7257 be needed. */
7258 dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
7259 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
7260
7261 /* Determine the size of one stub entry. */
7262 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
7263 ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
7264 : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
7265
7266 /* In the worst case, we'll get one stub per dynamic symbol, plus
7267 one to account for the dummy entry at the end required by IRIX
7268 rld. */
7269 loadable_size += htab->function_stub_size * (i + 1);
7270
7271 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7272 /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS_GOT16
7273 relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
7274 not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE. */
7275 local_gotno = 0;
7276 else
7277 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
7278 sections. Is 5 enough? */
7279 local_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
7280
7281 g->local_gotno += local_gotno;
7282 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7283
7284 g->global_gotno = i;
7285 s->size += i * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7286
7287 /* We need to calculate tls_gotno for global symbols at this point
7288 instead of building it up earlier, to avoid doublecounting
7289 entries for one global symbol from multiple input files. */
7290 count_tls_arg.info = info;
7291 count_tls_arg.needed = 0;
7292 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7293 mips_elf_count_global_tls_entries,
7294 &count_tls_arg);
7295 g->tls_gotno += count_tls_arg.needed;
7296 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7297
7298 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7299
7300 /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs. It initializes $gp to
7301 __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
7302 dynamic loader. */
7303 if (!htab->is_vxworks && s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
7304 {
7305 if (! mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, g, s, local_gotno))
7306 return FALSE;
7307 }
7308 else
7309 {
7310 /* Set up TLS entries for the first GOT. */
7311 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
7312 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, g);
7313 }
7314
7315 return TRUE;
7316 }
7317
7318 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
7319
7320 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)7321 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
7322 struct bfd_link_info *info)
7323 {
7324 bfd *dynobj;
7325 asection *s, *sreldyn;
7326 bfd_boolean reltext;
7327 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7328
7329 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7330 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
7331 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
7332
7333 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7334 {
7335 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
7336 if (info->executable)
7337 {
7338 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".interp");
7339 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
7340 s->size
7341 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
7342 s->contents
7343 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
7344 }
7345 }
7346
7347 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
7348 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
7349 memory for them. */
7350 reltext = FALSE;
7351 sreldyn = NULL;
7352 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
7353 {
7354 const char *name;
7355
7356 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
7357 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
7358 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
7359
7360 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
7361 continue;
7362
7363 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
7364 {
7365 if (s->size != 0)
7366 {
7367 const char *outname;
7368 asection *target;
7369
7370 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
7371 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
7372 If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
7373 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
7374 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
7375 not. */
7376 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
7377 s->output_section);
7378 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
7379 if ((target != NULL
7380 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
7381 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7382 || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7383 reltext = TRUE;
7384
7385 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
7386 to copy relocs into the output file. */
7387 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
7388 s->reloc_count = 0;
7389
7390 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
7391 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
7392 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
7393 will move them around between input sections'
7394 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
7395 broken, so don't let it run. */
7396 info->combreloc = 0;
7397 }
7398 }
7399 else if (htab->is_vxworks && strcmp (name, ".got") == 0)
7400 {
7401 /* Executables do not need a GOT. */
7402 if (info->shared)
7403 {
7404 /* Allocate relocations for all but the reserved entries. */
7405 struct mips_got_info *g;
7406 unsigned int count;
7407
7408 g = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7409 count = (g->global_gotno
7410 + g->local_gotno
7411 - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7412 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, count);
7413 }
7414 }
7415 else if (!htab->is_vxworks && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".got"))
7416 {
7417 /* _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections() has already done
7418 most of the work, but some symbols may have been mapped
7419 to versions that we must now resolve in the got_entries
7420 hash tables. */
7421 struct mips_got_info *gg = mips_elf_got_info (dynobj, NULL);
7422 struct mips_got_info *g = gg;
7423 struct mips_elf_set_global_got_offset_arg set_got_offset_arg;
7424 unsigned int needed_relocs = 0;
7425
7426 if (gg->next)
7427 {
7428 set_got_offset_arg.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
7429 set_got_offset_arg.info = info;
7430
7431 /* NOTE 2005-02-03: How can this call, or the next, ever
7432 find any indirect entries to resolve? They were all
7433 resolved in mips_elf_multi_got. */
7434 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (gg);
7435 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
7436 {
7437 unsigned int save_assign;
7438
7439 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (g);
7440
7441 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries. */
7442 save_assign = g->assigned_gotno;
7443 g->assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno;
7444 set_got_offset_arg.g = g;
7445 set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs = 0;
7446 htab_traverse (g->got_entries,
7447 mips_elf_set_global_got_offset,
7448 &set_got_offset_arg);
7449 needed_relocs += set_got_offset_arg.needed_relocs;
7450 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno - g->local_gotno
7451 <= g->global_gotno);
7452
7453 g->assigned_gotno = save_assign;
7454 if (info->shared)
7455 {
7456 needed_relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_gotno;
7457 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
7458 + g->next->global_gotno
7459 + g->next->tls_gotno
7460 + MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info));
7461 }
7462 }
7463 }
7464 else
7465 {
7466 struct mips_elf_count_tls_arg arg;
7467 arg.info = info;
7468 arg.needed = 0;
7469
7470 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_count_local_tls_relocs,
7471 &arg);
7472 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info),
7473 mips_elf_count_global_tls_relocs,
7474 &arg);
7475
7476 needed_relocs += arg.needed;
7477 }
7478
7479 if (needed_relocs)
7480 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
7481 needed_relocs);
7482 }
7483 else if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)) == 0)
7484 {
7485 /* IRIX rld assumes that the function stub isn't at the end
7486 of .text section. So put a dummy. XXX */
7487 s->size += htab->function_stub_size;
7488 }
7489 else if (! info->shared
7490 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
7491 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
7492 {
7493 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
7494 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
7495 s->size += 4;
7496 }
7497 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7498 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
7499 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
7500 else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
7501 && s != htab->sgotplt
7502 && s != htab->splt)
7503 {
7504 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
7505 continue;
7506 }
7507
7508 if (s->size == 0)
7509 {
7510 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7511 continue;
7512 }
7513
7514 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
7515 continue;
7516
7517 /* Allocate memory for this section last, since we may increase its
7518 size above. */
7519 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
7520 {
7521 sreldyn = s;
7522 continue;
7523 }
7524
7525 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
7526 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
7527 if (s->contents == NULL)
7528 {
7529 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7530 return FALSE;
7531 }
7532 }
7533
7534 /* Allocate memory for the .rel(a).dyn section. */
7535 if (sreldyn != NULL)
7536 {
7537 sreldyn->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, sreldyn->size);
7538 if (sreldyn->contents == NULL)
7539 {
7540 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
7541 return FALSE;
7542 }
7543 }
7544
7545 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
7546 {
7547 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
7548 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
7549 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
7550 the .dynamic section. */
7551
7552 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
7553 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. This must come first because glibc
7554 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and GDB only
7555 looks at the first one it sees. */
7556 if (!info->shared
7557 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
7558 return FALSE;
7559
7560 /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
7561 used by the debugger. */
7562 if (info->executable
7563 && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
7564 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
7565 return FALSE;
7566
7567 if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
7568 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
7569
7570 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
7571 {
7572 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
7573 return FALSE;
7574
7575 /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag. It will be set again if we
7576 write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
7577 at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
7578 absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative. */
7579 info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
7580 }
7581
7582 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
7583 return FALSE;
7584
7585 if (htab->is_vxworks)
7586 {
7587 /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn. It does not
7588 use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags. */
7589 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7590 {
7591 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
7592 return FALSE;
7593
7594 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
7595 return FALSE;
7596
7597 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
7598 return FALSE;
7599 }
7600 if (htab->splt->size > 0)
7601 {
7602 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
7603 return FALSE;
7604
7605 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
7606 return FALSE;
7607
7608 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
7609 return FALSE;
7610 }
7611 }
7612 else
7613 {
7614 if (mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE))
7615 {
7616 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
7617 return FALSE;
7618
7619 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
7620 return FALSE;
7621
7622 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
7623 return FALSE;
7624 }
7625
7626 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
7627 return FALSE;
7628
7629 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
7630 return FALSE;
7631
7632 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
7633 return FALSE;
7634
7635 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
7636 return FALSE;
7637
7638 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
7639 return FALSE;
7640
7641 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
7642 return FALSE;
7643
7644 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
7645 return FALSE;
7646
7647 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
7648 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
7649 return FALSE;
7650
7651 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
7652 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
7653 (dynobj, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
7654 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
7655 return FALSE;
7656 }
7657 }
7658
7659 return TRUE;
7660 }
7661
7662 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
7663 Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
7664 LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
7665 and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes. */
7666
7667 static void
mips_elf_adjust_addend(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel)7668 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7669 bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7670 asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
7671 {
7672 unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
7673 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7674 asection *sec;
7675
7676 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7677 {
7678 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7679 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_GPREL
7680 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL16
7681 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
7682 || r_type == R_MIPS_LITERAL)
7683 {
7684 rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
7685 rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
7686 }
7687
7688 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7689 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7690
7691 /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging. */
7692 if (!info->relocatable)
7693 {
7694 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7695 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7696 }
7697
7698 /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c. */
7699 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
7700 rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
7701 }
7702 }
7703
7704 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
7705
7706 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,bfd * input_bfd,asection * input_section,bfd_byte * contents,Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs,Elf_Internal_Sym * local_syms,asection ** local_sections)7707 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7708 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
7709 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7710 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7711 asection **local_sections)
7712 {
7713 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7714 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7715 bfd_vma addend = 0;
7716 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
7717 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7718
7719 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
7720 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
7721 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
7722 {
7723 const char *name;
7724 bfd_vma value = 0;
7725 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7726 bfd_boolean require_jalx;
7727 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
7728 REL relocation. */
7729 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
7730 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
7731 const char *msg;
7732 unsigned long r_symndx;
7733 asection *sec;
7734 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7735 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7736
7737 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
7738 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type,
7739 NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
7740 && (MIPS_RELOC_RELA_P
7741 (input_bfd, input_section,
7742 rel - relocs)));
7743
7744 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
7745 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
7746 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections, FALSE))
7747 {
7748 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7749 h = NULL;
7750 }
7751 else
7752 {
7753 unsigned long extsymoff;
7754
7755 extsymoff = 0;
7756 if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
7757 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7758 h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
7759 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
7760 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
7761 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
7762
7763 sec = NULL;
7764 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
7765 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
7766 sec = h->root.u.def.section;
7767 }
7768
7769 if (sec != NULL && elf_discarded_section (sec))
7770 {
7771 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7772 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7773 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7774 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7775 rel->r_info = 0;
7776 rel->r_addend = 0;
7777 continue;
7778 }
7779
7780 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
7781 {
7782 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
7783 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
7784 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
7785 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
7786 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
7787 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
7788 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
7789
7790 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
7791 of the reloc. */
7792 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7793 rel->r_offset += 4;
7794 }
7795
7796 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
7797 {
7798 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
7799
7800 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
7801 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
7802 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
7803 RELA relocation. To determine which flavor or relocation
7804 this is, we depend on the fact that the INPUT_SECTION's
7805 REL_HDR is read before its REL_HDR2. */
7806 rel_hdr = &elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr;
7807 if ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
7808 >= (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel))
7809 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (input_section)->rel_hdr2;
7810 if (rel_hdr->sh_entsize == MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (input_bfd))
7811 {
7812 bfd_byte *location = contents + rel->r_offset;
7813
7814 /* Note that this is a REL relocation. */
7815 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
7816
7817 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
7818 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7819 location);
7820 addend = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, input_bfd,
7821 contents);
7822 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle(input_bfd, r_type, FALSE,
7823 location);
7824
7825 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7826
7827 /* For some kinds of relocations, the ADDEND is a
7828 combination of the addend stored in two different
7829 relocations. */
7830 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
7831 || (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
7832 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
7833 local_sections, FALSE)))
7834 {
7835 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
7836 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
7837 int lo16_type;
7838
7839 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
7840 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
7841 else
7842 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
7843
7844 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend,
7845 left-shifted by sixteen bits, and the LO16
7846 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the code does
7847 a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of
7848 the LO16 value.)
7849
7850 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
7851
7852 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16
7853 relocation must be immediately following.
7854 However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next relocation
7855 may be a composed relocation consisting of
7856 several relocations for the same address. In
7857 that case, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation may occur
7858 as one of these. We permit a similar extension
7859 in general, as that is useful for GCC.
7860
7861 In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes
7862 the LO16 but keeps the corresponding HI16. This
7863 is strictly speaking a violation of the ABI but
7864 not immediately harmful. */
7865 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (input_bfd,
7866 lo16_type,
7867 rel, relend);
7868 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
7869 {
7870 const char *name;
7871
7872 if (h)
7873 name = h->root.root.string;
7874 else
7875 name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
7876 local_syms + r_symndx,
7877 sec);
7878 (*_bfd_error_handler)
7879 (_("%B: Can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s' for %s at 0x%lx in section `%A'"),
7880 input_bfd, input_section, name, howto->name,
7881 rel->r_offset);
7882 }
7883 else
7884 {
7885 bfd_byte *lo16_location;
7886 bfd_vma l;
7887
7888 lo16_location = contents + lo16_relocation->r_offset;
7889
7890 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
7891 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd,
7892 lo16_type, FALSE);
7893 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7894 FALSE, lo16_location);
7895 l = mips_elf_obtain_contents (lo16_howto,
7896 lo16_relocation,
7897 input_bfd, contents);
7898 _bfd_mips16_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, lo16_type,
7899 FALSE, lo16_location);
7900 l &= lo16_howto->src_mask;
7901 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
7902 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
7903
7904 addend <<= 16;
7905
7906 /* Compute the combined addend. */
7907 addend += l;
7908 }
7909 }
7910 else
7911 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
7912 }
7913 else
7914 addend = rel->r_addend;
7915 mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
7916 local_syms, local_sections, rel);
7917 }
7918
7919 if (info->relocatable)
7920 {
7921 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
7922 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7923 rel->r_offset -= 4;
7924
7925 if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
7926 {
7927 addend += rel->r_addend;
7928 if (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
7929 || r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
7930 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
7931 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
7932 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
7933 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
7934 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
7935 else
7936 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
7937
7938 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
7939 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
7940 source of the addend in the final link. */
7941 addend &= howto->src_mask;
7942
7943 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
7944 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
7945 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
7946 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
7947 but for endianness. */
7948 {
7949 bfd_vma sign_bits;
7950 bfd_vma low_bits;
7951 bfd_vma high_bits;
7952
7953 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
7954 #ifdef BFD64
7955 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
7956 #else
7957 sign_bits = -1;
7958 #endif
7959 else
7960 sign_bits = 0;
7961
7962 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
7963 do two separate stores. */
7964 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
7965 {
7966 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
7967 first. */
7968 low_bits = sign_bits;
7969 high_bits = addend;
7970 }
7971 else
7972 {
7973 low_bits = addend;
7974 high_bits = sign_bits;
7975 }
7976 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
7977 contents + rel->r_offset);
7978 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
7979 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
7980 continue;
7981 }
7982
7983 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
7984 input_bfd, input_section,
7985 contents, FALSE))
7986 return FALSE;
7987 }
7988
7989 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
7990 continue;
7991 }
7992
7993 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
7994 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
7995 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
7996 for the next. */
7997 if (rel + 1 < relend
7998 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
7999 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
8000 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
8001 else
8002 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
8003
8004 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
8005 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
8006 input_section, info, rel,
8007 addend, howto, local_syms,
8008 local_sections, &value,
8009 &name, &require_jalx,
8010 use_saved_addend_p))
8011 {
8012 case bfd_reloc_continue:
8013 /* There's nothing to do. */
8014 continue;
8015
8016 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
8017 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
8018 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
8019 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
8020 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
8021 continue;
8022
8023 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
8024 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
8025 info->callbacks->warning
8026 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
8027 return FALSE;
8028
8029 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
8030 if (use_saved_addend_p)
8031 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
8032 a given location. */
8033 ;
8034 else
8035 {
8036 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
8037 if (! ((*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
8038 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
8039 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset)))
8040 return FALSE;
8041 }
8042 break;
8043
8044 case bfd_reloc_ok:
8045 break;
8046
8047 default:
8048 abort ();
8049 break;
8050 }
8051
8052 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
8053 until we reach the last one. */
8054 if (use_saved_addend_p)
8055 {
8056 addend = value;
8057 continue;
8058 }
8059
8060 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8061 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
8062 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
8063 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
8064 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
8065 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
8066 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
8067 only a 32-bit VMA. */
8068 {
8069 bfd_vma sign_bits;
8070 bfd_vma low_bits;
8071 bfd_vma high_bits;
8072
8073 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
8074 #ifdef BFD64
8075 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
8076 #else
8077 sign_bits = -1;
8078 #endif
8079 else
8080 sign_bits = 0;
8081
8082 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
8083 do two separate stores. */
8084 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
8085 {
8086 /* Undo what we did above. */
8087 rel->r_offset -= 4;
8088 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
8089 first. */
8090 low_bits = sign_bits;
8091 high_bits = value;
8092 }
8093 else
8094 {
8095 low_bits = value;
8096 high_bits = sign_bits;
8097 }
8098 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
8099 contents + rel->r_offset);
8100 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
8101 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
8102 continue;
8103 }
8104
8105 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
8106 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
8107 input_bfd, input_section,
8108 contents, require_jalx))
8109 return FALSE;
8110 }
8111
8112 return TRUE;
8113 }
8114
8115 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
8116 adjust it appropriately now. */
8117
8118 static void
mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * name,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8119 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8120 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8121 {
8122 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
8123 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
8124 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
8125 "_ftext",
8126 "_etext",
8127 "__dso_displacement",
8128 "__elf_header",
8129 "__program_header_table",
8130 NULL
8131 };
8132
8133 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
8134 "_fdata",
8135 "_edata",
8136 "_end",
8137 "_fbss",
8138 NULL
8139 };
8140
8141 const char* const *p;
8142 int i;
8143
8144 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
8145 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
8146 *p;
8147 ++p)
8148 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
8149 {
8150 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
8151 IRIX6 linker. */
8152 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8153 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8154
8155 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
8156 if (i == 0)
8157 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8158 else
8159 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8160
8161 break;
8162 }
8163 }
8164
8165 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
8166 dynamic sections here. */
8167
8168 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8169 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8170 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8171 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8172 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8173 {
8174 bfd *dynobj;
8175 asection *sgot;
8176 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
8177 const char *name;
8178 int idx;
8179 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8180
8181 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8182 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8183
8184 if (h->plt.offset != MINUS_ONE)
8185 {
8186 asection *s;
8187 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
8188
8189 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
8190
8191 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8192
8193 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
8194 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
8195 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8196
8197 BFD_ASSERT ((htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8198 || (h->dynindx <= 0xffff));
8199
8200 /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed. Larger values would cause
8201 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
8202 index value. */
8203 if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
8204 return FALSE;
8205
8206 /* Fill the stub. */
8207 idx = 0;
8208 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8209 idx += 4;
8210 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE (output_bfd), stub + idx);
8211 idx += 4;
8212 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8213 {
8214 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
8215 stub + idx);
8216 idx += 4;
8217 }
8218 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
8219 idx += 4;
8220
8221 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
8222 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
8223 if (htab->function_stub_size == MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE)
8224 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8225 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
8226 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff), stub + idx);
8227 else
8228 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
8229 stub + idx);
8230
8231 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= s->size);
8232 memcpy (s->contents + h->plt.offset, stub, htab->function_stub_size);
8233
8234 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. plt.offset != -1 occurs
8235 only for the referenced symbol. */
8236 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8237
8238 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
8239 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
8240 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
8241 sym->st_value = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
8242 + h->plt.offset);
8243 }
8244
8245 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
8246 || h->forced_local);
8247
8248 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8249 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8250 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8251 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8252 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8253
8254 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
8255 the symbols that need them. */
8256 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8257 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8258 {
8259 bfd_vma offset;
8260 bfd_vma value;
8261
8262 value = sym->st_value;
8263 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h, R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8264 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
8265 }
8266
8267 if (g->next && h->dynindx != -1 && h->type != STT_TLS)
8268 {
8269 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
8270 bfd_vma entry;
8271 bfd_vma offset;
8272
8273 gg = g;
8274
8275 e.abfd = output_bfd;
8276 e.symndx = -1;
8277 e.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h;
8278 e.tls_type = 0;
8279
8280 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8281 {
8282 if (g->got_entries
8283 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
8284 &e)))
8285 {
8286 offset = p->gotidx;
8287 if (info->shared
8288 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
8289 && p->d.h != NULL
8290 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
8291 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
8292 {
8293 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
8294 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
8295 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
8296 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
8297 appropriate addend. */
8298 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8299
8300 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8301 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
8302 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
8303 else
8304 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
8305 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
8306
8307 entry = 0;
8308 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8309 (output_bfd, info, rel,
8310 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
8311 return FALSE;
8312 }
8313 else
8314 entry = sym->st_value;
8315 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
8316 }
8317 }
8318 }
8319
8320 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
8321 name = h->root.root.string;
8322 if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC") == 0
8323 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
8324 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8325 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
8326 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
8327 {
8328 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8329 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8330 sym->st_value = 1;
8331 }
8332 else if (strcmp (name, "_gp_disp") == 0 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
8333 {
8334 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8335 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8336 sym->st_value = elf_gp (output_bfd);
8337 }
8338 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
8339 {
8340 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
8341 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
8342 {
8343 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8344 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8345 sym->st_value = 0;
8346 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8347 }
8348 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
8349 {
8350 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8351 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
8352 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
8353 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
8354 }
8355 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
8356 {
8357 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
8358 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
8359 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
8360 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
8361 }
8362 }
8363
8364 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
8365 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
8366 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
8367
8368 if (! info->shared)
8369 {
8370 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8371 && (strcmp (name, "__rld_map") == 0
8372 || strcmp (name, "__RLD_MAP") == 0))
8373 {
8374 asection *s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map");
8375 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8376 sym->st_value = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8377 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0, s->contents);
8378 if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value == 0)
8379 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8380 }
8381 else if (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8382 && strcmp (name, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
8383 {
8384 /* IRIX6 does not use a .rld_map section. */
8385 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5
8386 || IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_none)
8387 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".rld_map")
8388 != NULL);
8389 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value = sym->st_value;
8390 }
8391 }
8392
8393 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
8394 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8395 sym->st_value &= ~1;
8396
8397 return TRUE;
8398 }
8399
8400 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
8401
8402 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)8403 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
8404 struct bfd_link_info *info,
8405 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
8406 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
8407 {
8408 bfd *dynobj;
8409 asection *sgot;
8410 struct mips_got_info *g;
8411 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8412
8413 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8414 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8415
8416 if (h->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8417 {
8418 bfd_byte *loc;
8419 bfd_vma plt_address, plt_index, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
8420 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8421 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8422
8423 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8424 BFD_ASSERT (htab->splt != NULL);
8425 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.offset <= htab->splt->size);
8426
8427 /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry. */
8428 plt_address = (htab->splt->output_section->vma
8429 + htab->splt->output_offset
8430 + h->plt.offset);
8431
8432 /* Calculate the index of the entry. */
8433 plt_index = ((h->plt.offset - htab->plt_header_size)
8434 / htab->plt_entry_size);
8435
8436 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
8437 got_address = (htab->sgotplt->output_section->vma
8438 + htab->sgotplt->output_offset
8439 + plt_index * 4);
8440
8441 /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
8442 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
8443 got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
8444
8445 /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
8446 entry. The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt. */
8447 branch_offset = -(h->plt.offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
8448
8449 /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry. */
8450 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
8451 htab->sgotplt->contents + plt_index * 4);
8452
8453 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
8454 loc = htab->splt->contents + h->plt.offset;
8455
8456 if (info->shared)
8457 {
8458 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
8459 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8460 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8461 }
8462 else
8463 {
8464 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
8465
8466 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
8467 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8468 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
8469
8470 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
8471 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | plt_index, loc + 4);
8472 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
8473 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
8474 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8475 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8476 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
8477 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
8478
8479 loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
8480 + (plt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8481
8482 /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry. */
8483 rel.r_offset = got_address;
8484 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8485 rel.r_addend = h->plt.offset;
8486 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8487
8488 /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>). */
8489 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8490 rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
8491 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8492 rel.r_addend = got_offset;
8493 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8494
8495 /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>). */
8496 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8497 rel.r_offset += 4;
8498 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8499 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8500 }
8501
8502 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
8503 loc = htab->srelplt->contents + plt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8504 rel.r_offset = got_address;
8505 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
8506 rel.r_addend = 0;
8507 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8508
8509 if (!h->def_regular)
8510 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8511 }
8512
8513 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
8514
8515 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8516 BFD_ASSERT (sgot != NULL);
8517 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8518 g = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8519 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8520
8521 /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT. */
8522 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL
8523 && h->dynindx >= g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
8524 {
8525 bfd_vma offset;
8526 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
8527 bfd_byte *loc;
8528 asection *s;
8529
8530 /* Install the symbol value in the GOT. */
8531 offset = mips_elf_global_got_index (dynobj, output_bfd, h,
8532 R_MIPS_GOT16, info);
8533 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
8534
8535 /* Add a dynamic relocation for it. */
8536 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8537 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
8538 outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
8539 + sgot->output_offset
8540 + offset);
8541 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
8542 outrel.r_addend = 0;
8543 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
8544 }
8545
8546 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
8547 if (h->needs_copy)
8548 {
8549 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8550
8551 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
8552
8553 rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8554 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8555 + h->root.u.def.value);
8556 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
8557 rel.r_addend = 0;
8558 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel,
8559 htab->srelbss->contents
8560 + (htab->srelbss->reloc_count
8561 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
8562 ++htab->srelbss->reloc_count;
8563 }
8564
8565 /* If this is a mips16 symbol, force the value to be even. */
8566 if (sym->st_other == STO_MIPS16)
8567 sym->st_value &= ~1;
8568
8569 return TRUE;
8570 }
8571
8572 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
8573 contents of .rela.plt.unloaded. */
8574
8575 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8576 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8577 {
8578 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
8579 bfd_byte *loc;
8580 bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
8581 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
8582 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8583
8584 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8585 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
8586
8587 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
8588 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
8589 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
8590 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
8591
8592 got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8593 got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
8594
8595 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
8596 plt_address = htab->splt->output_section->vma + htab->splt->output_offset;
8597
8598 /* Install the PLT header. */
8599 loc = htab->splt->contents;
8600 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
8601 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
8602 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
8603 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
8604 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
8605 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
8606
8607 /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
8608 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
8609 rela.r_offset = plt_address;
8610 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8611 rela.r_addend = 0;
8612 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8613 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8614
8615 /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
8616 %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
8617 rela.r_offset += 4;
8618 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8619 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
8620 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8621
8622 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
8623 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
8624 in which symbols were output. */
8625 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
8626 {
8627 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
8628
8629 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8630 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
8631 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8632 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8633
8634 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8635 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
8636 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8637 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8638
8639 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
8640 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
8641 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
8642 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8643 }
8644 }
8645
8646 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library. */
8647
8648 static void
mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8649 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8650 {
8651 unsigned int i;
8652 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8653
8654 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8655
8656 /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte. */
8657 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
8658 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
8659 htab->splt->contents + i * 4);
8660 }
8661
8662 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
8663
8664 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)8665 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
8666 struct bfd_link_info *info)
8667 {
8668 bfd *dynobj;
8669 asection *sdyn;
8670 asection *sgot;
8671 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
8672 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8673
8674 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8675 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8676
8677 sdyn = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".dynamic");
8678
8679 sgot = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
8680 if (sgot == NULL)
8681 gg = g = NULL;
8682 else
8683 {
8684 BFD_ASSERT (mips_elf_section_data (sgot) != NULL);
8685 gg = mips_elf_section_data (sgot)->u.got_info;
8686 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
8687 g = mips_elf_got_for_ibfd (gg, output_bfd);
8688 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8689 }
8690
8691 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8692 {
8693 bfd_byte *b;
8694 int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
8695
8696 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8697 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
8698
8699 for (b = sdyn->contents;
8700 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8701 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8702 {
8703 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8704 const char *name;
8705 size_t elemsize;
8706 asection *s;
8707 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8708
8709 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
8710 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8711
8712 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
8713 swap_out_p = TRUE;
8714
8715 switch (dyn.d_tag)
8716 {
8717 case DT_RELENT:
8718 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
8719 break;
8720
8721 case DT_RELAENT:
8722 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8723 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
8724 break;
8725
8726 case DT_STRSZ:
8727 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
8728 dyn.d_un.d_val =
8729 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
8730 break;
8731
8732 case DT_PLTGOT:
8733 name = ".got";
8734 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8735 {
8736 /* _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ is defined to be the beginning
8737 of the ".got" section in DYNOBJ. */
8738 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, name);
8739 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8740 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
8741 }
8742 else
8743 {
8744 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8745 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8746 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8747 }
8748 break;
8749
8750 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
8751 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
8752 break;
8753
8754 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
8755 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
8756 break;
8757
8758 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
8759 {
8760 time_t t;
8761 time (&t);
8762 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
8763 }
8764 break;
8765
8766 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
8767 /* XXX FIXME: */
8768 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8769 break;
8770
8771 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
8772 /* XXX FIXME: */
8773 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8774 break;
8775
8776 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
8777 s = output_bfd->sections;
8778 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8779 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
8780 break;
8781
8782 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
8783 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
8784 break;
8785
8786 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
8787 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
8788 entry of the first external symbol that is not
8789 referenced within the same object. */
8790 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
8791 break;
8792
8793 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
8794 if (gg->global_gotsym)
8795 {
8796 dyn.d_un.d_val = gg->global_gotsym->dynindx;
8797 break;
8798 }
8799 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
8800 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
8801 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, so we just fall through. */
8802
8803 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
8804 name = ".dynsym";
8805 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
8806 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, name);
8807 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8808
8809 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
8810 break;
8811
8812 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
8813 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - MIPS_RESERVED_GOTNO (info);
8814 break;
8815
8816 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
8817 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_value;
8818 break;
8819
8820 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
8821 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
8822 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
8823 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
8824 break;
8825
8826 case DT_RELASZ:
8827 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8828 /* The count does not include the JUMP_SLOT relocations. */
8829 if (htab->srelplt)
8830 dyn.d_un.d_val -= htab->srelplt->size;
8831 break;
8832
8833 case DT_PLTREL:
8834 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8835 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
8836 break;
8837
8838 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
8839 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8840 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->srelplt->size;
8841 break;
8842
8843 case DT_JMPREL:
8844 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
8845 dyn.d_un.d_val = (htab->srelplt->output_section->vma
8846 + htab->srelplt->output_offset);
8847 break;
8848
8849 case DT_TEXTREL:
8850 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
8851 the dynamic tag. */
8852 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8853 {
8854 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
8855 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8856 }
8857 break;
8858
8859 case DT_FLAGS:
8860 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
8861 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS. */
8862 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
8863 dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
8864 else
8865 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8866 break;
8867
8868 default:
8869 swap_out_p = FALSE;
8870 break;
8871 }
8872
8873 if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
8874 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
8875 (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
8876
8877 if (dyn_to_skip)
8878 {
8879 dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
8880 dyn_to_skip = 0;
8881 }
8882 }
8883
8884 /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag. */
8885 if (dyn_skipped > 0)
8886 memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
8887 }
8888
8889 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0)
8890 {
8891 if (htab->is_vxworks)
8892 {
8893 /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
8894 ".dynamic" section. The second is initialized by the
8895 loader and contains the shared library identifier.
8896 The third is also initialized by the loader and points
8897 to the lazy resolution stub. */
8898 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
8899 sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
8900 sgot->contents);
8901 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8902 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8903 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
8904 sgot->contents
8905 + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8906 }
8907 else
8908 {
8909 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
8910 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
8911 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
8912 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
8913 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0x80000000,
8914 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8915 }
8916
8917 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
8918 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8919 }
8920
8921 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
8922 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
8923 {
8924 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
8925 bfd_vma addend = 0;
8926
8927 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
8928 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
8929
8930 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
8931 {
8932 bfd_vma index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
8933 + g->next->tls_gotno;
8934
8935 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
8936 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8937 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0x80000000, sgot->contents
8938 + index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
8939
8940 if (! info->shared)
8941 continue;
8942
8943 while (index < g->assigned_gotno)
8944 {
8945 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
8946 = index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
8947 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
8948 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
8949 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
8950 0, &addend, sgot)))
8951 return FALSE;
8952 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
8953 }
8954 }
8955 }
8956
8957 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
8958 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
8959 here. */
8960
8961 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
8962 {
8963 bfd_byte *b;
8964 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
8965
8966 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
8967
8968 for (b = sdyn->contents;
8969 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
8970 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
8971 {
8972 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
8973 asection *s;
8974
8975 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
8976 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
8977
8978 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
8979 swap_out_p = TRUE;
8980
8981 switch (dyn.d_tag)
8982 {
8983 case DT_RELSZ:
8984 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
8985 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
8986 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
8987 are trailing null entries. */
8988 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
8989 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
8990 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
8991 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
8992 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
8993 /* Adjust the section size too. Tools like the prelinker
8994 can reasonably expect the values to the same. */
8995 elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
8996 = dyn.d_un.d_val;
8997 break;
8998
8999 default:
9000 swap_out_p = FALSE;
9001 break;
9002 }
9003
9004 if (swap_out_p)
9005 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
9006 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
9007 }
9008 }
9009
9010 {
9011 asection *s;
9012 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
9013
9014 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
9015 {
9016 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
9017 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
9018 if (s != NULL)
9019 {
9020 cpt.id1 = 1;
9021 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
9022 cpt.id2 = 2;
9023 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
9024 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
9025 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
9026 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
9027 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
9028 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
9029 s->contents));
9030
9031 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
9032 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (dynobj,
9033 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (dynobj));
9034 if (s != NULL)
9035 {
9036 file_ptr dummy_offset;
9037
9038 BFD_ASSERT (s->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
9039 dummy_offset = s->size - htab->function_stub_size;
9040 memset (s->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
9041 htab->function_stub_size);
9042 }
9043 }
9044 }
9045
9046 /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
9047 increasing order of r_symndx. The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
9048 this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
9049 relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful. */
9050 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9051 {
9052 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
9053 if (s != NULL
9054 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
9055 {
9056 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
9057
9058 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9059 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9060 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
9061 sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
9062 else
9063 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
9064 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
9065 sort_dynamic_relocs);
9066 }
9067 }
9068 }
9069
9070 if (htab->is_vxworks && htab->splt->size > 0)
9071 {
9072 if (info->shared)
9073 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
9074 else
9075 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
9076 }
9077 return TRUE;
9078 }
9079
9080
9081 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
9082
9083 static void
mips_set_isa_flags(bfd * abfd)9084 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
9085 {
9086 flagword val;
9087
9088 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
9089 {
9090 default:
9091 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
9092 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
9093 break;
9094
9095 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
9096 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
9097 break;
9098
9099 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
9100 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
9101 break;
9102
9103 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
9104 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
9105 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
9106 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
9107 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
9108 break;
9109
9110 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
9111 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
9112 break;
9113
9114 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
9115 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
9116 break;
9117
9118 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
9119 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
9120 break;
9121
9122 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
9123 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
9124 break;
9125
9126 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
9127 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
9128 break;
9129
9130 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
9131 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
9132 break;
9133
9134 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
9135 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
9136 break;
9137
9138 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
9139 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
9140 break;
9141
9142 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
9143 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
9144 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
9145 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
9146 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
9147 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
9148 break;
9149
9150 case bfd_mach_mips5:
9151 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
9152 break;
9153
9154 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
9155 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
9156 break;
9157
9158 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
9159 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
9160 break;
9161
9162 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
9163 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
9164 break;
9165
9166 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
9167 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
9168 break;
9169
9170 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
9171 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
9172 break;
9173
9174 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
9175 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
9176 break;
9177 }
9178 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
9179 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
9180
9181 }
9182
9183
9184 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
9185 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
9186 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
9187
9188 void
_bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing(bfd * abfd,bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9189 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd,
9190 bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9191 {
9192 unsigned int i;
9193 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
9194 const char *name;
9195 asection *sec;
9196
9197 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
9198 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
9199 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
9200 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
9201 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
9202
9203 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
9204 info for each special section. */
9205 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
9206 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
9207 i++, hdrpp++)
9208 {
9209 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
9210 {
9211 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
9212 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
9213 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
9214 if (sec != NULL)
9215 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9216 break;
9217
9218 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
9219 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9220 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9221 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9222 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
9223 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
9224 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9225 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9226 break;
9227
9228 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
9229 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9230 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9231 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
9232 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
9233 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9234 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
9235 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9236 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9237 break;
9238
9239 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
9240 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
9241 if (sec != NULL)
9242 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9243 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
9244 if (sec != NULL)
9245 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9246 break;
9247
9248 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
9249 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
9250 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
9251 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
9252 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
9253 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9254 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
9255 else
9256 {
9257 BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
9258 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9259 (name
9260 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
9261 }
9262 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
9263 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
9264 break;
9265
9266 }
9267 }
9268 }
9269
9270 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
9271 segments. */
9272
9273 int
_bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9274 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
9275 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9276 {
9277 asection *s;
9278 int ret = 0;
9279
9280 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
9281 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9282 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
9283 ++ret;
9284
9285 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
9286 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
9287 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
9288 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
9289 ++ret;
9290
9291 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
9292 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
9293 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
9294 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
9295 ++ret;
9296
9297 /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects. See
9298 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details. */
9299 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9300 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9301 ++ret;
9302
9303 return ret;
9304 }
9305
9306 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
9307
9308 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9309 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
9310 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9311 {
9312 asection *s;
9313 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
9314 bfd_size_type amt;
9315
9316 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
9317 segment. */
9318 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
9319 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9320 {
9321 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9322 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
9323 break;
9324 if (m == NULL)
9325 {
9326 amt = sizeof *m;
9327 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9328 if (m == NULL)
9329 return FALSE;
9330
9331 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
9332 m->count = 1;
9333 m->sections[0] = s;
9334
9335 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
9336 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9337 while (*pm != NULL
9338 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9339 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9340 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9341
9342 m->next = *pm;
9343 *pm = m;
9344 }
9345 }
9346
9347 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
9348 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
9349 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
9350 table. */
9351 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
9352 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
9353 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
9354 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
9355 now. */
9356 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
9357 {
9358 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
9359 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9360 break;
9361
9362 if (s)
9363 {
9364 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
9365
9366 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9367 while (*pm != NULL
9368 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
9369 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
9370 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9371
9372 if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
9373 {
9374 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
9375 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9376 options_segment->next = *pm;
9377 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
9378 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
9379 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
9380 options_segment->count = 1;
9381 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
9382 *pm = options_segment;
9383 }
9384 }
9385 }
9386 else
9387 {
9388 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
9389 {
9390 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
9391 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
9392 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
9393 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
9394 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
9395 {
9396 for (m = elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; m != NULL; m = m->next)
9397 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
9398 break;
9399 if (m == NULL)
9400 {
9401 amt = sizeof *m;
9402 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9403 if (m == NULL)
9404 return FALSE;
9405
9406 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
9407
9408 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
9409 if (s == NULL)
9410 {
9411 m->count = 0;
9412 m->p_flags = 0;
9413 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9414 }
9415 else
9416 {
9417 m->count = 1;
9418 m->sections[0] = s;
9419 }
9420
9421 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
9422 pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map;
9423 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
9424 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9425 if (*pm != NULL)
9426 pm = &(*pm)->next;
9427
9428 m->next = *pm;
9429 *pm = m;
9430 }
9431 }
9432 }
9433 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
9434 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
9435 between. */
9436 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL;
9437 pm = &(*pm)->next)
9438 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
9439 break;
9440 m = *pm;
9441 if (m != NULL && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_none)
9442 {
9443 /* For a normal mips executable the permissions for the PT_DYNAMIC
9444 segment are read, write and execute. We do that here since
9445 the code in elf.c sets only the read permission. This matters
9446 sometimes for the dynamic linker. */
9447 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
9448 {
9449 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_W | PF_X;
9450 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
9451 }
9452 }
9453 /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
9454 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
9455 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
9456 arrays of that size. An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
9457 be actively harmful in such cases. Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
9458 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
9459 which might move one of the other sections to a different
9460 PT_LOAD segment. */
9461 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9462 && m != NULL
9463 && m->count == 1
9464 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
9465 {
9466 static const char *sec_names[] =
9467 {
9468 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
9469 };
9470 bfd_vma low, high;
9471 unsigned int i, c;
9472 struct elf_segment_map *n;
9473
9474 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
9475 high = 0;
9476 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
9477 {
9478 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
9479 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
9480 {
9481 bfd_size_type sz;
9482
9483 if (low > s->vma)
9484 low = s->vma;
9485 sz = s->size;
9486 if (high < s->vma + sz)
9487 high = s->vma + sz;
9488 }
9489 }
9490
9491 c = 0;
9492 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9493 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9494 && s->vma >= low
9495 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9496 ++c;
9497
9498 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
9499 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9500 if (n == NULL)
9501 return FALSE;
9502 *n = *m;
9503 n->count = c;
9504
9505 i = 0;
9506 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
9507 {
9508 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
9509 && s->vma >= low
9510 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
9511 {
9512 n->sections[i] = s;
9513 ++i;
9514 }
9515 }
9516
9517 *pm = n;
9518 }
9519 }
9520
9521 /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
9522 like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
9523
9524 If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
9525 standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
9526 the new (writable) segment. However, the MIPS ABI requires
9527 .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
9528 start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
9529
9530 Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
9531 writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
9532 header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
9533 There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
9534 so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
9535 extension. */
9536 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
9537 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
9538 {
9539 for (pm = &elf_tdata (abfd)->segment_map; *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
9540 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
9541 break;
9542 if (*pm == NULL)
9543 {
9544 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
9545 if (m == NULL)
9546 return FALSE;
9547
9548 m->p_type = PT_NULL;
9549 *pm = m;
9550 }
9551 }
9552
9553 return TRUE;
9554 }
9555
9556 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
9557 relocation. */
9558
9559 asection *
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook(asection * sec,struct bfd_link_info * info,Elf_Internal_Rela * rel,struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)9560 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
9561 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9562 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
9563 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9564 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9565 {
9566 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
9567
9568 if (h != NULL)
9569 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
9570 {
9571 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
9572 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
9573 return NULL;
9574 }
9575
9576 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
9577 }
9578
9579 /* Update the got entry reference counts for the section being removed. */
9580
9581 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook(bfd * abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,struct bfd_link_info * info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const Elf_Internal_Rela * relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)9582 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_sweep_hook (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9583 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9584 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9585 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9586 {
9587 #if 0
9588 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9589 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
9590 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts;
9591 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel, *relend;
9592 unsigned long r_symndx;
9593 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9594
9595 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
9596 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
9597 local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
9598
9599 relend = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
9600 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel++)
9601 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info))
9602 {
9603 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
9604 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
9605 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9606 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9607 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9608 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9609 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
9610 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9611 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
9612 /* ??? It would seem that the existing MIPS code does no sort
9613 of reference counting or whatnot on its GOT and PLT entries,
9614 so it is not possible to garbage collect them at this time. */
9615 break;
9616
9617 default:
9618 break;
9619 }
9620 #endif
9621
9622 return TRUE;
9623 }
9624
9625 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
9626 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
9627 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
9628 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
9629
9630 void
_bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * dir,struct elf_link_hash_entry * ind)9631 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9632 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
9633 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
9634 {
9635 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
9636
9637 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
9638
9639 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9640 return;
9641
9642 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
9643 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
9644 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
9645 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
9646 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
9647 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
9648 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
9649
9650 if (dirmips->tls_type == 0)
9651 dirmips->tls_type = indmips->tls_type;
9652 }
9653
9654 void
_bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol(struct bfd_link_info * info,struct elf_link_hash_entry * entry,bfd_boolean force_local)9655 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9656 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
9657 bfd_boolean force_local)
9658 {
9659 bfd *dynobj;
9660 asection *got;
9661 struct mips_got_info *g;
9662 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9663
9664 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
9665 if (h->forced_local)
9666 return;
9667 h->forced_local = force_local;
9668
9669 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9670 if (dynobj != NULL && force_local && h->root.type != STT_TLS
9671 && (got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, TRUE)) != NULL
9672 && (g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info) != NULL)
9673 {
9674 if (g->next)
9675 {
9676 struct mips_got_entry e;
9677 struct mips_got_info *gg = g;
9678
9679 /* Since we're turning what used to be a global symbol into a
9680 local one, bump up the number of local entries of each GOT
9681 that had an entry for it. This will automatically decrease
9682 the number of global entries, since global_gotno is actually
9683 the upper limit of global entries. */
9684 e.abfd = dynobj;
9685 e.symndx = -1;
9686 e.d.h = h;
9687 e.tls_type = 0;
9688
9689 for (g = g->next; g != gg; g = g->next)
9690 if (htab_find (g->got_entries, &e))
9691 {
9692 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9693 g->local_gotno++;
9694 g->global_gotno--;
9695 }
9696
9697 /* If this was a global symbol forced into the primary GOT, we
9698 no longer need an entry for it. We can't release the entry
9699 at this point, but we must at least stop counting it as one
9700 of the symbols that required a forced got entry. */
9701 if (h->root.got.offset == 2)
9702 {
9703 BFD_ASSERT (gg->assigned_gotno > 0);
9704 gg->assigned_gotno--;
9705 }
9706 }
9707 else if (g->global_gotno == 0 && g->global_gotsym == NULL)
9708 /* If we haven't got through GOT allocation yet, just bump up the
9709 number of local entries, as this symbol won't be counted as
9710 global. */
9711 g->local_gotno++;
9712 else if (h->root.got.offset == 1)
9713 {
9714 /* If we're past non-multi-GOT allocation and this symbol had
9715 been marked for a global got entry, give it a local entry
9716 instead. */
9717 BFD_ASSERT (g->global_gotno > 0);
9718 g->local_gotno++;
9719 g->global_gotno--;
9720 }
9721 }
9722
9723 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, &h->root, force_local);
9724 }
9725
9726 #define PDR_SIZE 32
9727
9728 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_discard_info(bfd * abfd,struct elf_reloc_cookie * cookie,struct bfd_link_info * info)9729 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
9730 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9731 {
9732 asection *o;
9733 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
9734 unsigned char *tdata;
9735 size_t i, skip;
9736
9737 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
9738 if (! o)
9739 return FALSE;
9740 if (o->size == 0)
9741 return FALSE;
9742 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
9743 return FALSE;
9744 if (o->output_section != NULL
9745 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
9746 return FALSE;
9747
9748 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
9749 if (! tdata)
9750 return FALSE;
9751
9752 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
9753 info->keep_memory);
9754 if (!cookie->rels)
9755 {
9756 free (tdata);
9757 return FALSE;
9758 }
9759
9760 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
9761 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
9762
9763 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
9764 {
9765 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
9766 {
9767 tdata[i] = 1;
9768 skip ++;
9769 }
9770 }
9771
9772 if (skip != 0)
9773 {
9774 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
9775 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
9776 ret = TRUE;
9777 }
9778 else
9779 free (tdata);
9780
9781 if (! info->keep_memory)
9782 free (cookie->rels);
9783
9784 return ret;
9785 }
9786
9787 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs(asection * sec)9788 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
9789 {
9790 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
9791 return TRUE;
9792 return FALSE;
9793 }
9794
9795 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_write_section(bfd * output_bfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,asection * sec,bfd_byte * contents)9796 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
9797 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9798 asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
9799 {
9800 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
9801 int i;
9802
9803 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
9804 return FALSE;
9805
9806 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
9807 return FALSE;
9808
9809 to = contents;
9810 end = contents + sec->size;
9811 for (from = contents, i = 0;
9812 from < end;
9813 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
9814 {
9815 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
9816 continue;
9817 if (to != from)
9818 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
9819 to += PDR_SIZE;
9820 }
9821 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
9822 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
9823 return TRUE;
9824 }
9825
9826 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
9827 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
9828
9829 struct mips_elf_find_line
9830 {
9831 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
9832 struct ecoff_find_line i;
9833 };
9834
9835 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line(bfd * abfd,asection * section,asymbol ** symbols,bfd_vma offset,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9836 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
9837 asymbol **symbols, bfd_vma offset,
9838 const char **filename_ptr,
9839 const char **functionname_ptr,
9840 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9841 {
9842 asection *msec;
9843
9844 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9845 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9846 line_ptr))
9847 return TRUE;
9848
9849 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9850 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9851 line_ptr, ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 8 : 0,
9852 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9853 return TRUE;
9854
9855 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
9856 if (msec != NULL)
9857 {
9858 flagword origflags;
9859 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
9860 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
9861 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
9862
9863 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
9864 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
9865 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
9866 origflags = msec->flags;
9867 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
9868 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9869
9870 fi = elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
9871 if (fi == NULL)
9872 {
9873 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
9874 char *fraw_src;
9875 char *fraw_end;
9876 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
9877 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
9878
9879 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9880 if (fi == NULL)
9881 {
9882 msec->flags = origflags;
9883 return FALSE;
9884 }
9885
9886 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
9887 {
9888 msec->flags = origflags;
9889 return FALSE;
9890 }
9891
9892 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
9893 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
9894 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
9895 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
9896 {
9897 msec->flags = origflags;
9898 return FALSE;
9899 }
9900 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
9901 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
9902 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
9903 fraw_end = (fraw_src
9904 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
9905 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
9906 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
9907
9908 elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
9909
9910 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
9911 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
9912 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
9913 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
9914 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
9915 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
9916 }
9917
9918 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
9919 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9920 line_ptr))
9921 {
9922 msec->flags = origflags;
9923 return TRUE;
9924 }
9925
9926 msec->flags = origflags;
9927 }
9928
9929 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
9930
9931 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, section, symbols, offset,
9932 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9933 line_ptr);
9934 }
9935
9936 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info(bfd * abfd,const char ** filename_ptr,const char ** functionname_ptr,unsigned int * line_ptr)9937 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9938 const char **filename_ptr,
9939 const char **functionname_ptr,
9940 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9941 {
9942 bfd_boolean found;
9943 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9944 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9945 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9946 return found;
9947 }
9948
9949
9950 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
9951 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
9952 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
9953
9954 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents(bfd * abfd,sec_ptr section,const void * location,file_ptr offset,bfd_size_type count)9955 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
9956 const void *location,
9957 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
9958 {
9959 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
9960 {
9961 bfd_byte *c;
9962
9963 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9964 {
9965 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
9966 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
9967 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
9968 return FALSE;
9969 }
9970 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
9971 if (c == NULL)
9972 {
9973 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
9974 if (c == NULL)
9975 return FALSE;
9976 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
9977 }
9978
9979 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
9980 }
9981
9982 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
9983 count);
9984 }
9985
9986 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
9987 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
9988
9989 bfd_byte *
_bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * link_info,struct bfd_link_order * link_order,bfd_byte * data,bfd_boolean relocatable,asymbol ** symbols)9990 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
9991 (bfd *abfd,
9992 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
9993 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
9994 bfd_byte *data,
9995 bfd_boolean relocatable,
9996 asymbol **symbols)
9997 {
9998 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
9999 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
10000 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
10001 bfd_size_type sz;
10002
10003 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
10004 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
10005 long reloc_count;
10006
10007 if (reloc_size < 0)
10008 goto error_return;
10009
10010 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
10011 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
10012 goto error_return;
10013
10014 /* read in the section */
10015 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
10016 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
10017 goto error_return;
10018
10019 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
10020 input_section,
10021 reloc_vector,
10022 symbols);
10023 if (reloc_count < 0)
10024 goto error_return;
10025
10026 if (reloc_count > 0)
10027 {
10028 arelent **parent;
10029 /* for mips */
10030 int gp_found;
10031 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
10032
10033 {
10034 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
10035 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
10036 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
10037 if (abfd && input_bfd
10038 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
10039 lh = 0;
10040 else
10041 {
10042 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
10043 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
10044 }
10045 lookup:
10046 if (lh)
10047 {
10048 switch (lh->type)
10049 {
10050 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
10051 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
10052 case bfd_link_hash_common:
10053 gp_found = 0;
10054 break;
10055 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
10056 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
10057 gp_found = 1;
10058 gp = lh->u.def.value;
10059 break;
10060 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
10061 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
10062 lh = lh->u.i.link;
10063 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
10064 goto lookup;
10065 case bfd_link_hash_new:
10066 default:
10067 abort ();
10068 }
10069 }
10070 else
10071 gp_found = 0;
10072 }
10073 /* end mips */
10074 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
10075 {
10076 char *error_message = NULL;
10077 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
10078
10079 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
10080 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
10081 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
10082
10083 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
10084 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
10085 to the generic handling. */
10086 if (gp_found
10087 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
10088 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
10089 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
10090 input_section, relocatable,
10091 data, gp);
10092 else
10093 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
10094 input_section,
10095 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
10096 &error_message);
10097
10098 if (relocatable)
10099 {
10100 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
10101
10102 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
10103 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
10104 os->reloc_count++;
10105 }
10106
10107 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
10108 {
10109 switch (r)
10110 {
10111 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
10112 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
10113 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10114 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE)))
10115 goto error_return;
10116 break;
10117 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
10118 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
10119 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
10120 (link_info, error_message, input_bfd, input_section,
10121 (*parent)->address)))
10122 goto error_return;
10123 break;
10124 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
10125 if (!((*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
10126 (link_info, NULL,
10127 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
10128 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
10129 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address)))
10130 goto error_return;
10131 break;
10132 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
10133 default:
10134 abort ();
10135 break;
10136 }
10137
10138 }
10139 }
10140 }
10141 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10142 free (reloc_vector);
10143 return data;
10144
10145 error_return:
10146 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
10147 free (reloc_vector);
10148 return NULL;
10149 }
10150
10151 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
10152
10153 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10154 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10155 {
10156 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
10157 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
10158
10159 ret = bfd_malloc (amt);
10160 if (ret == NULL)
10161 return NULL;
10162
10163 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
10164 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
10165 sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry)))
10166 {
10167 free (ret);
10168 return NULL;
10169 }
10170
10171 #if 0
10172 /* We no longer use this. */
10173 for (i = 0; i < SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES; i++)
10174 ret->dynsym_sec_strindex[i] = (bfd_size_type) -1;
10175 #endif
10176 ret->procedure_count = 0;
10177 ret->compact_rel_size = 0;
10178 ret->use_rld_obj_head = FALSE;
10179 ret->rld_value = 0;
10180 ret->mips16_stubs_seen = FALSE;
10181 ret->is_vxworks = FALSE;
10182 ret->srelbss = NULL;
10183 ret->sdynbss = NULL;
10184 ret->srelplt = NULL;
10185 ret->srelplt2 = NULL;
10186 ret->sgotplt = NULL;
10187 ret->splt = NULL;
10188 ret->plt_header_size = 0;
10189 ret->plt_entry_size = 0;
10190 ret->function_stub_size = 0;
10191
10192 return &ret->root.root;
10193 }
10194
10195 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks. */
10196
10197 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
_bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create(bfd * abfd)10198 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10199 {
10200 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10201
10202 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10203 if (ret)
10204 {
10205 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10206
10207 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
10208 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10209 }
10210 return ret;
10211 }
10212
10213 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
10214 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
10215 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
10216
10217 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_final_link(bfd * abfd,struct bfd_link_info * info)10218 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
10219 {
10220 asection *o;
10221 struct bfd_link_order *p;
10222 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
10223 asection *rtproc_sec;
10224 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
10225 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
10226 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10227 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
10228 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
10229 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
10230 asection *s;
10231 EXTR esym;
10232 unsigned int i;
10233 bfd_size_type amt;
10234 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10235
10236 static const char * const secname[] =
10237 {
10238 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
10239 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
10240 };
10241 static const int sc[] =
10242 {
10243 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
10244 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
10245 };
10246
10247 /* We'd carefully arranged the dynamic symbol indices, and then the
10248 generic size_dynamic_sections renumbered them out from under us.
10249 Rather than trying somehow to prevent the renumbering, just do
10250 the sort again. */
10251 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10252 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10253 {
10254 bfd *dynobj;
10255 asection *got;
10256 struct mips_got_info *g;
10257 bfd_size_type dynsecsymcount;
10258
10259 /* When we resort, we must tell mips_elf_sort_hash_table what
10260 the lowest index it may use is. That's the number of section
10261 symbols we're going to add. The generic ELF linker only
10262 adds these symbols when building a shared object. Note that
10263 we count the sections after (possibly) removing the .options
10264 section above. */
10265
10266 dynsecsymcount = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info);
10267 if (! mips_elf_sort_hash_table (info, dynsecsymcount + 1))
10268 return FALSE;
10269
10270 /* Make sure we didn't grow the global .got region. */
10271 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10272 got = mips_elf_got_section (dynobj, FALSE);
10273 g = mips_elf_section_data (got)->u.got_info;
10274
10275 if (g->global_gotsym != NULL)
10276 BFD_ASSERT ((elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
10277 - g->global_gotsym->dynindx)
10278 <= g->global_gotno);
10279 }
10280
10281 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
10282 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
10283 {
10284 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
10285
10286 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10287 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10288 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
10289 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10290 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
10291 else if (htab->is_vxworks
10292 && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
10293 "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
10294 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
10295 && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
10296 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
10297 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
10298 + h->u.def.value);
10299 else if (info->relocatable)
10300 {
10301 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
10302
10303 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
10304 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10305 if (o->vma < lo
10306 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
10307 lo = o->vma;
10308
10309 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
10310 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
10311 }
10312 else
10313 {
10314 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
10315 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
10316 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
10317 }
10318 }
10319
10320 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
10321 information. */
10322 reginfo_sec = NULL;
10323 mdebug_sec = NULL;
10324 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
10325 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
10326 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
10327 {
10328 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
10329 {
10330 memset (®info, 0, sizeof reginfo);
10331
10332 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
10333 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10334 the information together. */
10335 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10336 {
10337 asection *input_section;
10338 bfd *input_bfd;
10339 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10340 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
10341
10342 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10343 {
10344 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10345 continue;
10346 abort ();
10347 }
10348
10349 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10350 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10351
10352 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
10353 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10354 return FALSE;
10355
10356 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
10357
10358 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
10359 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
10360 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
10361 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
10362 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
10363
10364 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
10365 mips_elf32_section_processing when the section is
10366 finally written out. */
10367
10368 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10369 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10370 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10371 }
10372
10373 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
10374 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
10375
10376 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10377 matters, but someday it might). */
10378 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10379
10380 reginfo_sec = o;
10381 }
10382
10383 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
10384 {
10385 struct extsym_info einfo;
10386 bfd_vma last;
10387
10388 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
10389 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
10390 the information together. */
10391 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
10392 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
10393 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
10394 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
10395 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
10396 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
10397 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
10398 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
10399 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
10400 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
10401 symhdr->issMax = 0;
10402 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
10403 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
10404 symhdr->crfd = 0;
10405 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
10406
10407 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
10408 debug_info structure. */
10409 debug.line = NULL;
10410 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
10411 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
10412 debug.external_sym = NULL;
10413 debug.external_opt = NULL;
10414 debug.external_aux = NULL;
10415 debug.ss = NULL;
10416 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
10417 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
10418 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
10419 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
10420
10421 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10422 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
10423 return FALSE;
10424
10425 esym.jmptbl = 0;
10426 esym.cobol_main = 0;
10427 esym.weakext = 0;
10428 esym.reserved = 0;
10429 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
10430 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
10431 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
10432 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
10433 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
10434 last = 0;
10435 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
10436 {
10437 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
10438 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
10439 if (s != NULL)
10440 {
10441 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
10442 last = s->vma + s->size;
10443 }
10444 else
10445 esym.asym.value = last;
10446 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
10447 secname[i], &esym))
10448 return FALSE;
10449 }
10450
10451 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10452 {
10453 asection *input_section;
10454 bfd *input_bfd;
10455 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
10456 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
10457 char *eraw_src;
10458 char *eraw_end;
10459
10460 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10461 {
10462 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10463 continue;
10464 abort ();
10465 }
10466
10467 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10468 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10469
10470 if (bfd_get_flavour (input_bfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
10471 || (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10472 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap) == NULL)
10473 {
10474 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
10475 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
10476 want to deal with it. */
10477 continue;
10478 }
10479
10480 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
10481 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
10482
10483 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
10484
10485 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
10486 read in the debugging information and set up an
10487 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
10488 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
10489 &input_debug))
10490 return FALSE;
10491
10492 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
10493 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
10494 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
10495 return FALSE;
10496
10497 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
10498 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
10499 the linker global hash table and save the information
10500 for the output external symbols. */
10501 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
10502 eraw_end = (eraw_src
10503 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
10504 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
10505 for (;
10506 eraw_src < eraw_end;
10507 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
10508 {
10509 EXTR ext;
10510 const char *name;
10511 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10512
10513 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
10514 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
10515 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
10516 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
10517 continue;
10518
10519 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
10520 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10521 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
10522 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
10523 continue;
10524
10525 if (ext.ifd != -1)
10526 {
10527 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
10528 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
10529 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
10530 }
10531
10532 h->esym = ext;
10533 }
10534
10535 /* Free up the information we just read. */
10536 free (input_debug.line);
10537 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
10538 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
10539 free (input_debug.external_sym);
10540 free (input_debug.external_opt);
10541 free (input_debug.external_aux);
10542 free (input_debug.ss);
10543 free (input_debug.ssext);
10544 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
10545 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
10546 free (input_debug.external_ext);
10547
10548 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10549 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10550 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10551 }
10552
10553 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && info->shared)
10554 {
10555 /* Create .rtproc section. */
10556 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10557 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
10558 {
10559 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
10560 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
10561
10562 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd,
10563 ".rtproc",
10564 flags);
10565 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
10566 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
10567 return FALSE;
10568 }
10569
10570 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
10571 info, rtproc_sec,
10572 &debug))
10573 return FALSE;
10574 }
10575
10576 /* Build the external symbol information. */
10577 einfo.abfd = abfd;
10578 einfo.info = info;
10579 einfo.debug = &debug;
10580 einfo.swap = swap;
10581 einfo.failed = FALSE;
10582 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
10583 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
10584 if (einfo.failed)
10585 return FALSE;
10586
10587 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
10588 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
10589
10590 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10591 matters, but someday it might). */
10592 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10593
10594 mdebug_sec = o;
10595 }
10596
10597 if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
10598 {
10599 const char *subname;
10600 unsigned int c;
10601 Elf32_gptab *tab;
10602 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
10603 unsigned int j;
10604
10605 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
10606 information describing how the small data area would
10607 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
10608 not used in executables files. */
10609 if (! info->relocatable)
10610 {
10611 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10612 {
10613 asection *input_section;
10614
10615 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10616 {
10617 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10618 continue;
10619 abort ();
10620 }
10621
10622 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10623
10624 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10625 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10626 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10627 }
10628
10629 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
10630 currently matters, but someday it might). */
10631 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10632
10633 /* Really remove the section. */
10634 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
10635 --abfd->section_count;
10636
10637 continue;
10638 }
10639
10640 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
10641 uninitialized data. */
10642 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
10643 gptab_data_sec = o;
10644 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
10645 gptab_bss_sec = o;
10646 else
10647 {
10648 (*_bfd_error_handler)
10649 (_("%s: illegal section name `%s'"),
10650 bfd_get_filename (abfd), o->name);
10651 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
10652 return FALSE;
10653 }
10654
10655 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
10656 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
10657 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
10658 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
10659 case we must change the name of the output section. */
10660 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10661 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
10662 {
10663 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
10664 o->name = ".gptab.data";
10665 else
10666 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
10667 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
10668 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
10669 }
10670
10671 /* Set up the first entry. */
10672 c = 1;
10673 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10674 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
10675 if (tab == NULL)
10676 return FALSE;
10677 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
10678 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
10679
10680 /* Combine the input sections. */
10681 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
10682 {
10683 asection *input_section;
10684 bfd *input_bfd;
10685 bfd_size_type size;
10686 unsigned long last;
10687 bfd_size_type gpentry;
10688
10689 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
10690 {
10691 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
10692 continue;
10693 abort ();
10694 }
10695
10696 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
10697 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
10698
10699 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
10700 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
10701 sorted by ascending -G value. */
10702 size = input_section->size;
10703 last = 0;
10704 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10705 gpentry < size;
10706 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
10707 {
10708 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
10709 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
10710 unsigned long val;
10711 unsigned long add;
10712 bfd_boolean exact;
10713 unsigned int look;
10714
10715 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
10716 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
10717 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
10718 {
10719 free (tab);
10720 return FALSE;
10721 }
10722
10723 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
10724 &int_gptab);
10725 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
10726 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
10727
10728 exact = FALSE;
10729 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10730 {
10731 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
10732 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
10733
10734 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
10735 exact = TRUE;
10736 }
10737
10738 if (! exact)
10739 {
10740 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
10741 unsigned int max;
10742
10743 /* We need a new table entry. */
10744 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
10745 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
10746 if (new_tab == NULL)
10747 {
10748 free (tab);
10749 return FALSE;
10750 }
10751 tab = new_tab;
10752 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
10753 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
10754
10755 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
10756 value, since that will be implied by this new
10757 value. */
10758 max = 0;
10759 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
10760 {
10761 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
10762 && (max == 0
10763 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
10764 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
10765 max = look;
10766 }
10767 if (max != 0)
10768 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
10769 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10770
10771 ++c;
10772 }
10773
10774 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
10775 }
10776
10777 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
10778 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
10779 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
10780 }
10781
10782 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
10783 if (c > 2)
10784 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
10785
10786 /* Swap out the table. */
10787 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10788 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
10789 if (ext_tab == NULL)
10790 {
10791 free (tab);
10792 return FALSE;
10793 }
10794
10795 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
10796 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
10797 free (tab);
10798
10799 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
10800 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
10801
10802 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
10803 matters, but someday it might). */
10804 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
10805 }
10806 }
10807
10808 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
10809 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
10810 return FALSE;
10811
10812 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
10813
10814 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
10815 {
10816 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
10817
10818 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, ®info, &ext);
10819 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
10820 return FALSE;
10821 }
10822
10823 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
10824 {
10825 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
10826 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
10827 swap, info,
10828 mdebug_sec->filepos))
10829 return FALSE;
10830
10831 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
10832 }
10833
10834 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
10835 {
10836 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
10837 gptab_data_sec->contents,
10838 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
10839 return FALSE;
10840 }
10841
10842 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
10843 {
10844 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
10845 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
10846 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
10847 return FALSE;
10848 }
10849
10850 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
10851 {
10852 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
10853 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
10854 {
10855 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
10856 rtproc_sec->contents,
10857 0, rtproc_sec->size))
10858 return FALSE;
10859 }
10860 }
10861
10862 return TRUE;
10863 }
10864
10865 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
10866
10867 struct mips_mach_extension {
10868 unsigned long extension, base;
10869 };
10870
10871
10872 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
10873 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
10874
10875 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] = {
10876 /* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
10877 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
10878
10879 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
10880 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10881 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
10882
10883 /* MIPS V extensions. */
10884 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
10885
10886 /* R10000 extensions. */
10887 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
10888
10889 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
10890 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
10891 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
10892 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
10893 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
10894 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
10895 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
10896
10897 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
10898 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10899 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10900 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10901 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10902 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
10903
10904 /* VR4100 extensions. */
10905 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10906 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
10907
10908 /* MIPS III extensions. */
10909 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10910 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10911 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10912 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10913 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10914 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10915 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
10916
10917 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
10918 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
10919
10920 /* MIPS II extensions. */
10921 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10922 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
10923
10924 /* MIPS I extensions. */
10925 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
10926 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
10927 };
10928
10929
10930 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
10931
10932 static bfd_boolean
mips_mach_extends_p(unsigned long base,unsigned long extension)10933 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
10934 {
10935 size_t i;
10936
10937 if (extension == base)
10938 return TRUE;
10939
10940 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
10941 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
10942 return TRUE;
10943
10944 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
10945 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
10946 return TRUE;
10947
10948 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
10949 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
10950 {
10951 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
10952 if (extension == base)
10953 return TRUE;
10954 }
10955
10956 return FALSE;
10957 }
10958
10959
10960 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
10961
10962 static bfd_boolean
mips_32bit_flags_p(flagword flags)10963 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
10964 {
10965 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
10966 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
10967 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
10968 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
10969 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
10970 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
10971 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
10972 }
10973
10974
10975 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
10976 there are conflicting attributes. */
10977 static bfd_boolean
mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)10978 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
10979 {
10980 obj_attribute *in_attr;
10981 obj_attribute *out_attr;
10982
10983 if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
10984 {
10985 /* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
10986 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
10987
10988 /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
10989 initialized. */
10990 elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
10991
10992 return TRUE;
10993 }
10994
10995 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
10996 non-conflicting ones. */
10997 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
10998 out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
10999 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11000 {
11001 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
11002 if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11003 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
11004 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == 0)
11005 ;
11006 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11007 _bfd_error_handler
11008 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), ibfd,
11009 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11010 else if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i > 3)
11011 _bfd_error_handler
11012 (_("Warning: %B uses unknown floating point ABI %d"), obfd,
11013 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i);
11014 else
11015 switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11016 {
11017 case 1:
11018 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11019 {
11020 case 2:
11021 _bfd_error_handler
11022 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11023 obfd, ibfd);
11024
11025 case 3:
11026 _bfd_error_handler
11027 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11028 obfd, ibfd);
11029 break;
11030
11031 default:
11032 abort ();
11033 }
11034 break;
11035
11036 case 2:
11037 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11038 {
11039 case 1:
11040 _bfd_error_handler
11041 (_("Warning: %B uses -msingle-float, %B uses -mdouble-float"),
11042 ibfd, obfd);
11043
11044 case 3:
11045 _bfd_error_handler
11046 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11047 obfd, ibfd);
11048 break;
11049
11050 default:
11051 abort ();
11052 }
11053 break;
11054
11055 case 3:
11056 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
11057 {
11058 case 1:
11059 case 2:
11060 _bfd_error_handler
11061 (_("Warning: %B uses hard float, %B uses soft float"),
11062 ibfd, obfd);
11063 break;
11064
11065 default:
11066 abort ();
11067 }
11068 break;
11069
11070 default:
11071 abort ();
11072 }
11073 }
11074
11075 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
11076 _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
11077
11078 return TRUE;
11079 }
11080
11081 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
11082 object file when linking. */
11083
11084 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data(bfd * ibfd,bfd * obfd)11085 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
11086 {
11087 flagword old_flags;
11088 flagword new_flags;
11089 bfd_boolean ok;
11090 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
11091 asection *sec;
11092
11093 /* Check if we have the same endianess */
11094 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, obfd))
11095 {
11096 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11097 (_("%B: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11098 ibfd);
11099 return FALSE;
11100 }
11101
11102 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
11103 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
11104 return TRUE;
11105
11106 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
11107 {
11108 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11109 (_("%B: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
11110 ibfd);
11111 return FALSE;
11112 }
11113
11114 if (!mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd))
11115 return FALSE;
11116
11117 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
11118 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11119 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
11120
11121 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
11122 {
11123 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
11124 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
11125 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11126 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
11127
11128 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
11129 && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
11130 || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
11131 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
11132 {
11133 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
11134 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11135 return FALSE;
11136 }
11137
11138 return TRUE;
11139 }
11140
11141 /* Check flag compatibility. */
11142
11143 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11144 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
11145
11146 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
11147 doesn't seem to matter. */
11148 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11149 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
11150
11151 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
11152 just be able to ignore this. */
11153 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11154 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
11155
11156 /* Don't care about the PIC flags from dynamic objects; they are
11157 PIC by design. */
11158 if ((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0
11159 && (ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
11160 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11161
11162 if (new_flags == old_flags)
11163 return TRUE;
11164
11165 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections.
11166 If not, its flags may not have been initialised either, but it cannot
11167 actually cause any incompatibility. */
11168 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
11169 {
11170 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
11171 which are automatically generated by gas. */
11172 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
11173 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
11174 && (sec->size != 0
11175 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
11176 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
11177 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
11178 {
11179 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
11180 break;
11181 }
11182 }
11183 if (null_input_bfd)
11184 return TRUE;
11185
11186 ok = TRUE;
11187
11188 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
11189 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
11190 {
11191 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11192 (_("%B: warning: linking PIC files with non-PIC files"),
11193 ibfd);
11194 ok = TRUE;
11195 }
11196
11197 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
11198 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
11199 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
11200 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
11201
11202 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11203 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
11204
11205 /* Compare the ISAs. */
11206 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
11207 {
11208 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11209 (_("%B: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
11210 ibfd);
11211 ok = FALSE;
11212 }
11213 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
11214 {
11215 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
11216 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
11217 {
11218 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
11219 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
11220 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
11221 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
11222 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
11223 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
11224 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11225
11226 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
11227 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
11228 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
11229 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
11230 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
11231 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
11232 }
11233 else
11234 {
11235 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
11236 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11237 (_("%B: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11238 ibfd,
11239 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
11240 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
11241 ok = FALSE;
11242 }
11243 }
11244
11245 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11246 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
11247
11248 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
11249 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
11250 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
11251 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11252 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11253 {
11254 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
11255 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11256 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
11257 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
11258 {
11259 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11260 (_("%B: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
11261 ibfd,
11262 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
11263 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
11264 ok = FALSE;
11265 }
11266 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11267 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
11268 }
11269
11270 /* For now, allow arbitrary mixing of ASEs (retain the union). */
11271 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
11272 {
11273 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11274
11275 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11276 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
11277 }
11278
11279 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
11280 if (new_flags != old_flags)
11281 {
11282 (*_bfd_error_handler)
11283 (_("%B: uses different e_flags (0x%lx) fields than previous modules (0x%lx)"),
11284 ibfd, (unsigned long) new_flags,
11285 (unsigned long) old_flags);
11286 ok = FALSE;
11287 }
11288
11289 if (! ok)
11290 {
11291 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
11292 return FALSE;
11293 }
11294
11295 return TRUE;
11296 }
11297
11298 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
11299
11300 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags(bfd * abfd,flagword flags)11301 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
11302 {
11303 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
11304 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
11305
11306 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
11307 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
11308 return TRUE;
11309 }
11310
11311 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data(bfd * abfd,void * ptr)11312 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
11313 {
11314 FILE *file = ptr;
11315
11316 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
11317
11318 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
11319 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
11320
11321 /* xgettext:c-format */
11322 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
11323
11324 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
11325 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
11326 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
11327 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
11328 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
11329 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
11330 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
11331 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
11332 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
11333 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
11334 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
11335 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
11336 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
11337 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
11338 else
11339 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
11340
11341 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
11342 fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
11343 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
11344 fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
11345 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
11346 fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
11347 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
11348 fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
11349 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
11350 fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
11351 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
11352 fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
11353 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
11354 fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
11355 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
11356 fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
11357 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
11358 fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
11359 else
11360 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
11361
11362 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
11363 fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
11364
11365 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
11366 fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
11367
11368 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
11369 fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
11370 else
11371 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
11372
11373 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
11374 fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
11375
11376 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
11377 fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
11378
11379 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
11380 fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
11381
11382 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
11383 fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
11384
11385 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
11386 fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
11387
11388 fputc ('\n', file);
11389
11390 return TRUE;
11391 }
11392
11393 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
11394 {
11395 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11396 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11397 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
11398 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11399 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
11400 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"), 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
11401 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
11402 };
11403
11404 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes. Ensure that the
11405 STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
11406 definiton of the symbol. */
11407 void
_bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h,const Elf_Internal_Sym * isym,bfd_boolean definition,bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11408 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11409 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
11410 bfd_boolean definition,
11411 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11412 {
11413 if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
11414 {
11415 unsigned char other;
11416
11417 other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
11418 other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
11419 h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
11420 }
11421
11422 if (!definition
11423 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
11424 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
11425 }
11426
11427 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
11428 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
11429 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol(struct elf_link_hash_entry * h)11430 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
11431 {
11432 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
11433 }
11434
11435 bfd_boolean
_bfd_mips_elf_common_definition(Elf_Internal_Sym * sym)11436 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11437 {
11438 return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
11439 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
11440 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
11441 }
11442